1 #ifndef __LINUX_NL80211_H
2 #define __LINUX_NL80211_H
3 /*
4  * 802.11 netlink interface public header
5  *
6  * Copyright 2006-2010 Johannes Berg <[email protected]>
7  * Copyright 2008 Michael Wu <[email protected]>
8  * Copyright 2008 Luis Carlos Cobo <[email protected]>
9  * Copyright 2008 Michael Buesch <[email protected]>
10  * Copyright 2008, 2009 Luis R. Rodriguez <[email protected]>
11  * Copyright 2008 Jouni Malinen <[email protected]>
12  * Copyright 2008 Colin McCabe <[email protected]>
13  * Copyright 2015-2017	Intel Deutschland GmbH
14  * Copyright (C) 2018-2024 Intel Corporation
15  *
16  * Permission to use, copy, modify, and/or distribute this software for any
17  * purpose with or without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above
18  * copyright notice and this permission notice appear in all copies.
19  *
20  * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" AND THE AUTHOR DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES
21  * WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
22  * MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR
23  * ANY SPECIAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
24  * WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN
25  * ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING OUT OF
26  * OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
27  *
28  */
29 
30 /*
31  * This header file defines the userspace API to the wireless stack. Please
32  * be careful not to break things - i.e. don't move anything around or so
33  * unless you can demonstrate that it breaks neither API nor ABI.
34  *
35  * Additions to the API should be accompanied by actual implementations in
36  * an upstream driver, so that example implementations exist in case there
37  * are ever concerns about the precise semantics of the API or changes are
38  * needed, and to ensure that code for dead (no longer implemented) API
39  * can actually be identified and removed.
40  * Nonetheless, semantics should also be documented carefully in this file.
41  */
42 
43 #include <linux/types.h>
44 
45 #define NL80211_GENL_NAME "nl80211"
46 
47 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_CONFIG		"config"
48 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_SCAN		"scan"
49 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_REG		"regulatory"
50 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_MLME		"mlme"
51 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_VENDOR		"vendor"
52 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_NAN		"nan"
53 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_TESTMODE	"testmode"
54 
55 #define NL80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_MIN	4
56 #define NL80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_MAX	15
57 #define NL80211_EDMG_CHANNELS_MIN	1
58 #define NL80211_EDMG_CHANNELS_MAX	0x3c /* 0b00111100 */
59 
60 /**
61  * DOC: Station handling
62  *
63  * Stations are added per interface, but a special case exists with VLAN
64  * interfaces. When a station is bound to an AP interface, it may be moved
65  * into a VLAN identified by a VLAN interface index (%NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN).
66  * The station is still assumed to belong to the AP interface it was added
67  * to.
68  *
69  * Station handling varies per interface type and depending on the driver's
70  * capabilities.
71  *
72  * For drivers supporting TDLS with external setup (WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS
73  * and WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP), the station lifetime is as follows:
74  *  - a setup station entry is added, not yet authorized, without any rate
75  *    or capability information; this just exists to avoid race conditions
76  *  - when the TDLS setup is done, a single NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION is valid
77  *    to add rate and capability information to the station and at the same
78  *    time mark it authorized.
79  *  - %NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK is then used
80  *  - after this, the only valid operation is to remove it by tearing down
81  *    the TDLS link (%NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK)
82  *
83  * TODO: need more info for other interface types
84  */
85 
86 /**
87  * DOC: Frame transmission/registration support
88  *
89  * Frame transmission and registration support exists to allow userspace
90  * management entities such as wpa_supplicant to react to management frames
91  * that are not being handled by the kernel. This includes, for example,
92  * certain classes of action frames that cannot be handled in the kernel
93  * for various reasons.
94  *
95  * Frame registration is done on a per-interface basis and registrations
96  * cannot be removed other than by closing the socket. It is possible to
97  * specify a registration filter to register, for example, only for a
98  * certain type of action frame. In particular with action frames, those
99  * that userspace registers for will not be returned as unhandled by the
100  * driver, so that the registered application has to take responsibility
101  * for doing that.
102  *
103  * The type of frame that can be registered for is also dependent on the
104  * driver and interface type. The frame types are advertised in wiphy
105  * attributes so applications know what to expect.
106  *
107  * NOTE: When an interface changes type while registrations are active,
108  *       these registrations are ignored until the interface type is
109  *       changed again. This means that changing the interface type can
110  *       lead to a situation that couldn't otherwise be produced, but
111  *       any such registrations will be dormant in the sense that they
112  *       will not be serviced, i.e. they will not receive any frames.
113  *
114  * Frame transmission allows userspace to send for example the required
115  * responses to action frames. It is subject to some sanity checking,
116  * but many frames can be transmitted. When a frame is transmitted, its
117  * status is indicated to the sending socket.
118  *
119  * For more technical details, see the corresponding command descriptions
120  * below.
121  */
122 
123 /**
124  * DOC: Virtual interface / concurrency capabilities
125  *
126  * Some devices are able to operate with virtual MACs; they can have
127  * more than one virtual interface. The capability handling for this
128  * is a bit complex though, as there may be a number of restrictions
129  * on the types of concurrency that are supported.
130  *
131  * To start with, each device supports the interface types listed in
132  * the %NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES attribute, but by listing the
133  * types there no concurrency is implied.
134  *
135  * Once concurrency is desired, more attributes must be observed:
136  * To start with, since some interface types are purely managed in
137  * software, like the AP-VLAN type in mac80211 for example, there's
138  * an additional list of these; they can be added at any time and
139  * are only restricted by some semantic restrictions (e.g. AP-VLAN
140  * cannot be added without a corresponding AP interface). This list
141  * is exported in the %NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES attribute.
142  *
143  * Further, the list of supported combinations is exported. This is
144  * in the %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS attribute. Basically,
145  * it exports a list of "groups", and at any point in time the
146  * interfaces that are currently active must fall into any one of
147  * the advertised groups. Within each group, there are restrictions
148  * on the number of interfaces of different types that are supported
149  * and also the number of different channels, along with potentially
150  * some other restrictions. See &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs.
151  *
152  * All together, these attributes define the concurrency of virtual
153  * interfaces that a given device supports.
154  */
155 
156 /**
157  * DOC: packet coalesce support
158  *
159  * In most cases, host that receives IPv4 and IPv6 multicast/broadcast
160  * packets does not do anything with these packets. Therefore the
161  * reception of these unwanted packets causes unnecessary processing
162  * and power consumption.
163  *
164  * Packet coalesce feature helps to reduce number of received interrupts
165  * to host by buffering these packets in firmware/hardware for some
166  * predefined time. Received interrupt will be generated when one of the
167  * following events occurs.
168  * a) Expiration of hardware timer whose expiration time is set to maximum
169  * coalescing delay of matching coalesce rule.
170  * b) Coalescing buffer in hardware reaches its limit.
171  * c) Packet doesn't match any of the configured coalesce rules.
172  *
173  * User needs to configure following parameters for creating a coalesce
174  * rule.
175  * a) Maximum coalescing delay
176  * b) List of packet patterns which needs to be matched
177  * c) Condition for coalescence: pattern 'match' or 'no match'
178  * Multiple such rules can be created.
179  */
180 
181 /**
182  * DOC: WPA/WPA2 EAPOL handshake offload
183  *
184  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK flag drivers
185  * can indicate they support offloading EAPOL handshakes for WPA/WPA2
186  * preshared key authentication in station mode. In %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
187  * the preshared key should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_PMK. Drivers
188  * supporting this offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT when no
189  * preshared key material is provided, for example when that driver does
190  * not support setting the temporal keys through %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY.
191  *
192  * Similarly @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X flag can be
193  * set by drivers indicating offload support of the PTK/GTK EAPOL
194  * handshakes during 802.1X authentication in station mode. In order to
195  * use the offload the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT should have
196  * %NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS attribute flag. Drivers supporting this
197  * offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT when the attribute flag is
198  * not present.
199  *
200  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK flag drivers
201  * can indicate they support offloading EAPOL handshakes for WPA/WPA2
202  * preshared key authentication in AP mode. In %NL80211_CMD_START_AP
203  * the preshared key should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_PMK. Drivers
204  * supporting this offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_START_AP when no
205  * preshared key material is provided, for example when that driver does
206  * not support setting the temporal keys through %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY.
207  *
208  * For 802.1X the PMK or PMK-R0 are set by providing %NL80211_ATTR_PMK
209  * using %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK. For offloaded FT support also
210  * %NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME must be provided.
211  */
212 
213 /**
214  * DOC: FILS shared key authentication offload
215  *
216  * FILS shared key authentication offload can be advertised by drivers by
217  * setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD flag. The drivers that support
218  * FILS shared key authentication offload should be able to construct the
219  * authentication and association frames for FILS shared key authentication and
220  * eventually do a key derivation as per IEEE 802.11ai. The below additional
221  * parameters should be given to driver in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and/or in
222  * %NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS.
223  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME - used to construct keyname_nai
224  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM - used to construct keyname_nai
225  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM - used to construct erp message
226  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK - used to generate the rIK and rMSK
227  * rIK should be used to generate an authentication tag on the ERP message and
228  * rMSK should be used to derive a PMKSA.
229  * rIK, rMSK should be generated and keyname_nai, sequence number should be used
230  * as specified in IETF RFC 6696.
231  *
232  * When FILS shared key authentication is completed, driver needs to provide the
233  * below additional parameters to userspace, which can be either after setting
234  * up a connection or after roaming.
235  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - used for key renewal
236  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM - used in further EAP-RP exchanges
237  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PMKID - used to identify the PMKSA used/generated
238  *	%Nl80211_ATTR_PMK - used to update PMKSA cache in userspace
239  * The PMKSA can be maintained in userspace persistently so that it can be used
240  * later after reboots or wifi turn off/on also.
241  *
242  * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID is the cache identifier advertised by a FILS
243  * capable AP supporting PMK caching. It specifies the scope within which the
244  * PMKSAs are cached in an ESS. %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA and
245  * %NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA are enhanced to allow support for PMKSA caching based
246  * on FILS cache identifier. Additionally %NL80211_ATTR_PMK is used with
247  * %NL80211_SET_PMKSA to specify the PMK corresponding to a PMKSA for driver to
248  * use in a FILS shared key connection with PMKSA caching.
249  */
250 
251 /**
252  * DOC: SAE authentication offload
253  *
254  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD flag drivers can indicate they
255  * support offloading SAE authentication for WPA3-Personal networks in station
256  * mode. Similarly @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP flag can be set by
257  * drivers indicating the offload support in AP mode.
258  *
259  * The password for SAE should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD in
260  * %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP for station and AP mode
261  * respectively.
262  */
263 
264 /**
265  * DOC: VLAN offload support for setting group keys and binding STAs to VLANs
266  *
267  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD flag drivers can indicate they
268  * support offloading VLAN functionality in a manner where the driver exposes a
269  * single netdev that uses VLAN tagged frames and separate VLAN-specific netdevs
270  * can then be added using RTM_NEWLINK/IFLA_VLAN_ID similarly to the Ethernet
271  * case. Frames received from stations that are not assigned to any VLAN are
272  * delivered on the main netdev and frames to such stations can be sent through
273  * that main netdev.
274  *
275  * %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY (for group keys), %NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION, and
276  * %NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION will optionally specify vlan_id using
277  * %NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID.
278  */
279 
280 /**
281  * DOC: TID configuration
282  *
283  * TID config support can be checked in the %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG
284  * attribute given in wiphy capabilities.
285  *
286  * The necessary configuration parameters are mentioned in
287  * &enum nl80211_tid_config_attr and it will be passed to the
288  * %NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG command in %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG.
289  *
290  * If the configuration needs to be applied for specific peer then the MAC
291  * address of the peer needs to be passed in %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, otherwise the
292  * configuration will be applied for all the connected peers in the vif except
293  * any peers that have peer-specific configuration for the TID by default; if
294  * the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE flag is set, peer-specific values
295  * will be overwritten.
296  *
297  * All this configuration is valid only for STA's current connection,
298  * i.e., the configuration will be reset to default when the STA connects back
299  * after disconnection/roaming, and this configuration will be cleared when
300  * the interface goes down.
301  */
302 
303 /**
304  * DOC: FILS shared key crypto offload
305  *
306  * This feature is applicable to drivers running in AP mode.
307  *
308  * FILS shared key crypto offload can be advertised by drivers by setting
309  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD flag. The drivers that support
310  * FILS shared key crypto offload should be able to encrypt and decrypt
311  * association frames for FILS shared key authentication as per IEEE 802.11ai.
312  * With this capability, for FILS key derivation, drivers depend on userspace.
313  *
314  * After FILS key derivation, userspace shares the FILS AAD details with the
315  * driver and the driver stores the same to use in decryption of association
316  * request and in encryption of association response. The below parameters
317  * should be given to the driver in %NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD.
318  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC - STA MAC address, used for storing FILS AAD per STA
319  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - Used for encryption or decryption
320  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES - Used for encryption or decryption
321  *			(STA Nonce 16 bytes followed by AP Nonce 16 bytes)
322  *
323  * Once the association is done, the driver cleans the FILS AAD data.
324  */
325 
326 /**
327  * DOC: Multi-Link Operation
328  *
329  * In Multi-Link Operation, a connection between two MLDs utilizes multiple
330  * links. To use this in nl80211, various commands and responses now need
331  * to or will include the new %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS attribute.
332  * Additionally, various commands that need to operate on a specific link
333  * now need to be given the %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID attribute, e.g. to
334  * use %NL80211_CMD_START_AP or similar functions.
335  */
336 
337 /**
338  * DOC: OWE DH IE handling offload
339  *
340  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD flag, drivers can indicate
341  * kernel/application space to avoid DH IE handling. When this flag is
342  * advertised, the driver/device will take care of DH IE inclusion and
343  * processing of peer DH IE to generate PMK.
344  */
345 
346 /**
347  * enum nl80211_commands - supported nl80211 commands
348  *
349  * @NL80211_CMD_UNSPEC: unspecified command to catch errors
350  *
351  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY: request information about a wiphy or dump request
352  *	to get a list of all present wiphys.
353  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY: set wiphy parameters, needs %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY or
354  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX; can be used to set %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME,
355  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ,
356  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET (and the attributes determining the
357  *	channel width; this is used for setting monitor mode channel),
358  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG,
359  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD, and/or
360  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD.  However, for setting the channel,
361  *	see %NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL instead, the support here is for backward
362  *	compatibility only.
363  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_WIPHY: Newly created wiphy, response to get request
364  *	or rename notification. Has attributes %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and
365  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME.
366  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_WIPHY: Wiphy deleted. Has attributes
367  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME.
368  *
369  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE: Request an interface's configuration;
370  *	either a dump request for all interfaces or a specific get with a
371  *	single %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is supported.
372  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_INTERFACE: Set type of a virtual interface, requires
373  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE.
374  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE: Newly created virtual interface or response
375  *	to %NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE. Has %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX,
376  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE attributes. Can also
377  *	be sent from userspace to request creation of a new virtual interface,
378  *	then requires attributes %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE and
379  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME.
380  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_INTERFACE: Virtual interface was deleted, has attributes
381  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY. Can also be sent from
382  *	userspace to request deletion of a virtual interface, then requires
383  *	attribute %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. If multiple BSSID advertisements are
384  *	enabled using %NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG, %NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS,
385  *	and if this command is used for the transmitting interface, then all
386  *	the non-transmitting interfaces are deleted as well.
387  *
388  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_KEY: Get sequence counter information for a key specified
389  *	by %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX and/or %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
390  *	represents peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key. For MLO group key,
391  *	the link is identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
392  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY: Set key attributes %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT,
393  *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT, or %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_THRESHOLD.
394  *	For MLO connection, the link to set default key is identified by
395  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
396  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY: add a key with given %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA,
397  *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER,
398  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ attributes. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC represents
399  *	peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key. The link to add MLO
400  *	group key is identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
401  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_KEY: delete a key identified by %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX
402  *	or %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC represents peer's MLD address
403  *	for MLO pairwise key. The link to delete group key is identified by
404  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
405  *
406  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_BEACON: (not used)
407  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON: change the beacon on an access point interface
408  *	using the %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD and %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL
409  *	attributes. For drivers that generate the beacon and probe responses
410  *	internally, the following attributes must be provided: %NL80211_ATTR_IE,
411  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP and %NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP.
412  * @NL80211_CMD_START_AP: Start AP operation on an AP interface, parameters
413  *	are like for %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON, and additionally parameters that
414  *	do not change are used, these include %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL,
415  *	%NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD, %NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
416  *	%NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID, %NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE,
417  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP, %NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS,
418  *	%NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES, %NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY,
419  *	%NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT,
420  *	%NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS.
421  *	The channel to use can be set on the interface or be given using the
422  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET, and the
423  *	attributes determining channel width.
424  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON: old alias for %NL80211_CMD_START_AP
425  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP: Stop AP operation on the given interface
426  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_BEACON: old alias for %NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP
427  *
428  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION: Get station attributes for station identified by
429  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
430  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION: Set station attributes for station identified by
431  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
432  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION: Add a station with given attributes to the
433  *	interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
434  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_STATION: Remove a station identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
435  *	or, if no MAC address given, all stations, on the interface identified
436  *	by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. For MLD station, MLD address is used in
437  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE and
438  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE can optionally be used to specify which type
439  *	of disconnection indication should be sent to the station
440  *	(Deauthentication or Disassociation frame and reason code for that
441  *	frame). %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID can be used optionally to remove
442  *	stations connected and using at least that link as one of its links.
443  *
444  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH: Get mesh path attributes for mesh path to
445  *	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
446  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
447  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MPATH:  Set mesh path attributes for mesh path to
448  *	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
449  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
450  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_MPATH: Create a new mesh path for the destination given by
451  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC via %NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP.
452  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_MPATH: Delete a mesh path to the destination given by
453  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC.
454  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS: Set BSS attributes for BSS identified by
455  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
456  *
457  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_REG: ask the wireless core to send us its currently set
458  *	regulatory domain. If %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY is specified and the device
459  *	has a private regulatory domain, it will be returned. Otherwise, the
460  *	global regdomain will be returned.
461  *	A device will have a private regulatory domain if it uses the
462  *	regulatory_hint() API. Even when a private regdomain is used the channel
463  *	information will still be mended according to further hints from
464  *	the regulatory core to help with compliance. A dump version of this API
465  *	is now available which will returns the global regdomain as well as
466  *	all private regdomains of present wiphys (for those that have it).
467  *	If a wiphy is self-managed (%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG), then
468  *	its private regdomain is the only valid one for it. The regulatory
469  *	core is not used to help with compliance in this case.
470  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_REG: Set current regulatory domain. CRDA sends this command
471  *	after being queried by the kernel. CRDA replies by sending a regulatory
472  *	domain structure which consists of %NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA set to our
473  *	current alpha2 if it found a match. It also provides
474  *	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS, and a set of regulatory rules. Each
475  *	regulatory rule is a nested set of attributes  given by
476  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FREQ_[START|END] and
477  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW with an attached power rule given by
478  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_POWER_MAX_ANT_GAIN and
479  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_POWER_MAX_EIRP.
480  * @NL80211_CMD_REQ_SET_REG: ask the wireless core to set the regulatory domain
481  *	to the specified ISO/IEC 3166-1 alpha2 country code. The core will
482  *	store this as a valid request and then query userspace for it.
483  *
484  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG: Get mesh networking properties for the
485  *	interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX
486  *
487  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG: Set mesh networking properties for the
488  *      interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX
489  *
490  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE: Set extra IEs for management frames. The
491  *	interface is identified with %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and the management
492  *	frame subtype with %NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE. The extra IE data to be
493  *	added to the end of the specified management frame is specified with
494  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IE. If the command succeeds, the requested data will be
495  *	added to all specified management frames generated by
496  *	kernel/firmware/driver.
497  *	Note: This command has been removed and it is only reserved at this
498  *	point to avoid re-using existing command number. The functionality this
499  *	command was planned for has been provided with cleaner design with the
500  *	option to specify additional IEs in NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN,
501  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE,
502  *	NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE, and NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE.
503  *
504  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN: get scan results
505  * @NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN: trigger a new scan with the given parameters
506  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE is used to decide whether to send the
507  *	probe requests at CCK rate or not. %NL80211_ATTR_BSSID can be used to
508  *	specify a BSSID to scan for; if not included, the wildcard BSSID will
509  *	be used.
510  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_SCAN_RESULTS: scan notification (as a reply to
511  *	NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN and on the "scan" multicast group)
512  * @NL80211_CMD_SCAN_ABORTED: scan was aborted, for unspecified reasons,
513  *	partial scan results may be available
514  *
515  * @NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN: start a scheduled scan at certain
516  *	intervals and certain number of cycles, as specified by
517  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS. If %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS is
518  *	not specified and only %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL is specified,
519  *	scheduled scan will run in an infinite loop with the specified interval.
520  *	These attributes are mutually exclusive,
521  *	i.e. NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL must not be passed if
522  *	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS is defined.
523  *	If for some reason scheduled scan is aborted by the driver, all scan
524  *	plans are canceled (including scan plans that did not start yet).
525  *	Like with normal scans, if SSIDs (%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS)
526  *	are passed, they are used in the probe requests.  For
527  *	broadcast, a broadcast SSID must be passed (ie. an empty
528  *	string).  If no SSID is passed, no probe requests are sent and
529  *	a passive scan is performed.  %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES,
530  *	if passed, define which channels should be scanned; if not
531  *	passed, all channels allowed for the current regulatory domain
532  *	are used.  Extra IEs can also be passed from the userspace by
533  *	using the %NL80211_ATTR_IE attribute.  The first cycle of the
534  *	scheduled scan can be delayed by %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY
535  *	is supplied. If the device supports multiple concurrent scheduled
536  *	scans, it will allow such when the caller provides the flag attribute
537  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI to indicate user-space support for it.
538  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN: stop a scheduled scan. Returns -ENOENT if
539  *	scheduled scan is not running. The caller may assume that as soon
540  *	as the call returns, it is safe to start a new scheduled scan again.
541  * @NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_RESULTS: indicates that there are scheduled scan
542  *	results available.
543  * @NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED: indicates that the scheduled scan has
544  *	stopped.  The driver may issue this event at any time during a
545  *	scheduled scan.  One reason for stopping the scan is if the hardware
546  *	does not support starting an association or a normal scan while running
547  *	a scheduled scan.  This event is also sent when the
548  *	%NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN command is received or when the interface
549  *	is brought down while a scheduled scan was running.
550  *
551  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY: get survey results, e.g. channel occupation
552  *      or noise level
553  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_SURVEY_RESULTS: survey data notification (as a reply to
554  *	NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY and on the "scan" multicast group)
555  *
556  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA: Add a PMKSA cache entry using %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
557  *	(for the BSSID), %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, and optionally %NL80211_ATTR_PMK
558  *	(PMK is used for PTKSA derivation in case of FILS shared key offload) or
559  *	using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID, %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID,
560  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, and %NL80211_ATTR_PMK in case of FILS
561  *	authentication where %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID is the identifier
562  *	advertised by a FILS capable AP identifying the scope of PMKSA in an
563  *	ESS.
564  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA: Delete a PMKSA cache entry, using %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
565  *	(for the BSSID) and %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID or using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
566  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID, and %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID in case of FILS
567  *	authentication. Additionally in case of SAE offload and OWE offloads
568  *	PMKSA entry can be deleted using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID.
569  * @NL80211_CMD_FLUSH_PMKSA: Flush all PMKSA cache entries.
570  *
571  * @NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE: indicates to userspace the regulatory domain
572  *	has been changed and provides details of the request information
573  *	that caused the change such as who initiated the regulatory request
574  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR), the wiphy_idx
575  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2) on which the request was made from if
576  *	the initiator was %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE or
577  *	%NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER, the type of regulatory domain
578  *	set (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE), if the type of regulatory domain is
579  *	%NL80211_REG_TYPE_COUNTRY the alpha2 to which we have moved on
580  *	to (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2).
581  * @NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT: indicates to userspace that an AP beacon
582  *	has been found while world roaming thus enabling active scan or
583  *	any mode of operation that initiates TX (beacons) on a channel
584  *	where we would not have been able to do either before. As an example
585  *	if you are world roaming (regulatory domain set to world or if your
586  *	driver is using a custom world roaming regulatory domain) and while
587  *	doing a passive scan on the 5 GHz band you find an AP there (if not
588  *	on a DFS channel) you will now be able to actively scan for that AP
589  *	or use AP mode on your card on that same channel. Note that this will
590  *	never be used for channels 1-11 on the 2 GHz band as they are always
591  *	enabled world wide. This beacon hint is only sent if your device had
592  *	either disabled active scanning or beaconing on a channel. We send to
593  *	userspace the wiphy on which we removed a restriction from
594  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY) and the channel on which this occurred
595  *	before (%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE) and after (%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER)
596  *	the beacon hint was processed.
597  *
598  * @NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE: authentication request and notification.
599  *	This command is used both as a command (request to authenticate) and
600  *	as an event on the "mlme" multicast group indicating completion of the
601  *	authentication process.
602  *	When used as a command, %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to identify the
603  *	interface. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is used to specify PeerSTAAddress (and
604  *	BSSID in case of station mode). %NL80211_ATTR_SSID is used to specify
605  *	the SSID (mainly for association, but is included in authentication
606  *	request, too, to help BSS selection. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ +
607  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET is used to specify the frequency of the
608  *	channel in MHz. %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE is used to specify the
609  *	authentication type. %NL80211_ATTR_IE is used to define IEs
610  *	(VendorSpecificInfo, but also including RSN IE and FT IEs) to be added
611  *	to the frame.
612  *	When used as an event, this reports reception of an Authentication
613  *	frame in station and IBSS modes when the local MLME processed the
614  *	frame, i.e., it was for the local STA and was received in correct
615  *	state. This is similar to MLME-AUTHENTICATE.confirm primitive in the
616  *	MLME SAP interface (kernel providing MLME, userspace SME). The
617  *	included %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME attribute contains the management frame
618  *	(including both the header and frame body, but not FCS). This event is
619  *	also used to indicate if the authentication attempt timed out. In that
620  *	case the %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME attribute is replaced with a
621  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT flag (and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC to indicate which
622  *	pending authentication timed out).
623  * @NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE: association request and notification; like
624  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Association and Reassociation
625  *	(similar to MLME-ASSOCIATE.request, MLME-REASSOCIATE.request,
626  *	MLME-ASSOCIATE.confirm or MLME-REASSOCIATE.confirm primitives). The
627  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID attribute is used to specify whether the
628  *	request is for the initial association to an ESS (that attribute not
629  *	included) or for reassociation within the ESS (that attribute is
630  *	included).
631  * @NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE: deauthentication request and notification; like
632  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Deauthentication frames (similar to
633  *	MLME-DEAUTHENTICATION.request and MLME-DEAUTHENTICATE.indication
634  *	primitives).
635  * @NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE: disassociation request and notification; like
636  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Disassociation frames (similar to
637  *	MLME-DISASSOCIATE.request and MLME-DISASSOCIATE.indication primitives).
638  *
639  * @NL80211_CMD_MICHAEL_MIC_FAILURE: notification of a locally detected Michael
640  *	MIC (part of TKIP) failure; sent on the "mlme" multicast group; the
641  *	event includes %NL80211_ATTR_MAC to describe the source MAC address of
642  *	the frame with invalid MIC, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE to show the key
643  *	type, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX to indicate the key identifier, and
644  *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ to indicate the TSC value of the frame; this
645  *	event matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication() primitive
646  *
647  * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS: Join a new IBSS -- given at least an SSID and a
648  *	FREQ attribute (for the initial frequency if no peer can be found)
649  *	and optionally a MAC (as BSSID) and FREQ_FIXED attribute if those
650  *	should be fixed rather than automatically determined. Can only be
651  *	executed on a network interface that is UP, and fixed BSSID/FREQ
652  *	may be rejected. Another optional parameter is the beacon interval,
653  *	given in the %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL attribute, which if not
654  *	given defaults to 100 TU (102.4ms).
655  * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_IBSS: Leave the IBSS -- no special arguments, the IBSS is
656  *	determined by the network interface.
657  *
658  * @NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE: testmode command, takes a wiphy (or ifindex) attribute
659  *	to identify the device, and the TESTDATA blob attribute to pass through
660  *	to the driver.
661  *
662  * @NL80211_CMD_CONNECT: connection request and notification; this command
663  *	requests to connect to a specified network but without separating
664  *	auth and assoc steps. For this, you need to specify the SSID in a
665  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SSID attribute, and can optionally specify the association
666  *	IEs in %NL80211_ATTR_IE, %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE,
667  *	%NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ,
668  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET, %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT,
669  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
670  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT,
671  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT, and
672  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT.
673  *	If included, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ are
674  *	restrictions on BSS selection, i.e., they effectively prevent roaming
675  *	within the ESS. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT
676  *	can be included to provide a recommendation of the initial BSS while
677  *	allowing the driver to roam to other BSSes within the ESS and also to
678  *	ignore this recommendation if the indicated BSS is not ideal. Only one
679  *	set of BSSID,frequency parameters is used (i.e., either the enforcing
680  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC,%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ or the less strict
681  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT).
682  *	Driver shall not modify the IEs specified through %NL80211_ATTR_IE if
683  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC is included. However, if %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT is
684  *	included, these IEs through %NL80211_ATTR_IE are specified by the user
685  *	space based on the best possible BSS selected. Thus, if the driver ends
686  *	up selecting a different BSS, it can modify these IEs accordingly (e.g.
687  *	userspace asks the driver to perform PMKSA caching with BSS1 and the
688  *	driver ends up selecting BSS2 with different PMKSA cache entry; RSNIE
689  *	has to get updated with the apt PMKID).
690  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID can be used to request a reassociation within
691  *	the ESS in case the device is already associated and an association with
692  *	a different BSS is desired.
693  *	Background scan period can optionally be
694  *	specified in %NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD,
695  *	if not specified default background scan configuration
696  *	in driver is used and if period value is 0, bg scan will be disabled.
697  *	This attribute is ignored if driver does not support roam scan.
698  *	It is also sent as an event, with the BSSID and response IEs when the
699  *	connection is established or failed to be established. This can be
700  *	determined by the %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE attribute (0 = success,
701  *	non-zero = failure). If %NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT is included in the
702  *	event, the connection attempt failed due to not being able to initiate
703  *	authentication/association or not receiving a response from the AP.
704  *	Non-zero %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE value is indicated in that case as
705  *	well to remain backwards compatible.
706  * @NL80211_CMD_ROAM: Notification indicating the card/driver roamed by itself.
707  *	When a security association was established on an 802.1X network using
708  *	fast transition, this event should be followed by an
709  *	%NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED event.
710  *	Following a %NL80211_CMD_ROAM event userspace can issue
711  *	%NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN in order to obtain the scan information for the
712  *	new BSS the card/driver roamed to.
713  * @NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT: drop a given connection; also used to notify
714  *	userspace that a connection was dropped by the AP or due to other
715  *	reasons, for this the %NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP and
716  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE attributes are used.
717  *
718  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY_NETNS: Set a wiphy's netns. Note that all devices
719  *	associated with this wiphy must be down and will follow.
720  *
721  * @NL80211_CMD_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Request to remain awake on the specified
722  *	channel for the specified amount of time. This can be used to do
723  *	off-channel operations like transmit a Public Action frame and wait for
724  *	a response while being associated to an AP on another channel.
725  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify which interface (and thus
726  *	radio) is used. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used to specify the
727  *	frequency for the operation.
728  *	%NL80211_ATTR_DURATION is used to specify the duration in milliseconds
729  *	to remain on the channel. This command is also used as an event to
730  *	notify when the requested duration starts (it may take a while for the
731  *	driver to schedule this time due to other concurrent needs for the
732  *	radio).
733  *	When called, this operation returns a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE)
734  *	that will be included with any events pertaining to this request;
735  *	the cookie is also used to cancel the request.
736  * @NL80211_CMD_CANCEL_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: This command can be used to cancel a
737  *	pending remain-on-channel duration if the desired operation has been
738  *	completed prior to expiration of the originally requested duration.
739  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY or %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify the
740  *	radio. The %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE attribute must be given as well to
741  *	uniquely identify the request.
742  *	This command is also used as an event to notify when a requested
743  *	remain-on-channel duration has expired.
744  *
745  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK: Set the mask of rates to be used in TX
746  *	rate selection. %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify the interface
747  *	and @NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES the set of allowed rates.
748  *
749  * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME: Register for receiving certain mgmt frames
750  *	(via @NL80211_CMD_FRAME) for processing in userspace. This command
751  *	requires an interface index, a frame type attribute (optional for
752  *	backward compatibility reasons, if not given assumes action frames)
753  *	and a match attribute containing the first few bytes of the frame
754  *	that should match, e.g. a single byte for only a category match or
755  *	four bytes for vendor frames including the OUI. The registration
756  *	cannot be dropped, but is removed automatically when the netlink
757  *	socket is closed. Multiple registrations can be made.
758  *	The %NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST flag attribute can be given if
759  *	%NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS is available, in which
760  *	case the registration can also be modified to include/exclude the
761  *	flag, rather than requiring unregistration to change it.
762  * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_ACTION: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME for
763  *	backward compatibility
764  * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME: Management frame TX request and RX notification. This
765  *	command is used both as a request to transmit a management frame and
766  *	as an event indicating reception of a frame that was not processed in
767  *	kernel code, but is for us (i.e., which may need to be processed in a
768  *	user space application). %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the
769  *	frame contents (including header). %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used
770  *	to indicate on which channel the frame is to be transmitted or was
771  *	received. If this channel is not the current channel (remain-on-channel
772  *	or the operational channel) the device will switch to the given channel
773  *	and transmit the frame, optionally waiting for a response for the time
774  *	specified using %NL80211_ATTR_DURATION. When called, this operation
775  *	returns a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE) that will be included with the
776  *	TX status event pertaining to the TX request.
777  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE is used to decide whether to send the
778  *	management frames at CCK rate or not in 2GHz band.
779  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX is an array of offsets to CSA
780  *	counters which will be updated to the current value. This attribute
781  *	is used during CSA period.
782  *	For TX on an MLD, the frequency can be omitted and the link ID be
783  *	specified, or if transmitting to a known peer MLD (with MLD addresses
784  *	in the frame) both can be omitted and the link will be selected by
785  *	lower layers.
786  *	For RX notification, %NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to
787  *	indicate the frame RX timestamp and %NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP may
788  *	be included to indicate the ack TX timestamp.
789  * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_WAIT_CANCEL: When an off-channel TX was requested, this
790  *	command may be used with the corresponding cookie to cancel the wait
791  *	time if it is known that it is no longer necessary.  This command is
792  *	also sent as an event whenever the driver has completed the off-channel
793  *	wait time.
794  * @NL80211_CMD_ACTION: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_FRAME for backward compatibility.
795  * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS: Report TX status of a management frame
796  *	transmitted with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME. %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE identifies
797  *	the TX command and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME includes the contents of the
798  *	frame. %NL80211_ATTR_ACK flag is included if the recipient acknowledged
799  *	the frame. %NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to indicate the
800  *	tx timestamp and %NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to
801  *	indicate the ack RX timestamp.
802  * @NL80211_CMD_ACTION_TX_STATUS: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS for
803  *	backward compatibility.
804  *
805  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_POWER_SAVE: Set powersave, using %NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE
806  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_POWER_SAVE: Get powersave status in %NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE
807  *
808  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_CQM: Connection quality monitor configuration. This command
809  *	is used to configure connection quality monitoring notification trigger
810  *	levels.
811  * @NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM: Connection quality monitor notification. This
812  *	command is used as an event to indicate the that a trigger level was
813  *	reached.
814  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL: Set the channel (using %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
815  *	and the attributes determining channel width) the given interface
816  *	(identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX) shall operate on.
817  *	In case multiple channels are supported by the device, the mechanism
818  *	with which it switches channels is implementation-defined.
819  *	When a monitor interface is given, it can only switch channel while
820  *	no other interfaces are operating to avoid disturbing the operation
821  *	of any other interfaces, and other interfaces will again take
822  *	precedence when they are used.
823  *
824  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WDS_PEER: Set the MAC address of the peer on a WDS interface
825  *	(no longer supported).
826  *
827  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST: Configure if this AP should perform
828  *	multicast to unicast conversion. When enabled, all multicast packets
829  *	with ethertype ARP, IPv4 or IPv6 (possibly within an 802.1Q header)
830  *	will be sent out to each station once with the destination (multicast)
831  *	MAC address replaced by the station's MAC address. Note that this may
832  *	break certain expectations of the receiver, e.g. the ability to drop
833  *	unicast IP packets encapsulated in multicast L2 frames, or the ability
834  *	to not send destination unreachable messages in such cases.
835  *	This can only be toggled per BSS. Configure this on an interface of
836  *	type %NL80211_IFTYPE_AP. It applies to all its VLAN interfaces
837  *	(%NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN), except for those in 4addr (WDS) mode.
838  *	If %NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED is not present with this
839  *	command, the feature is disabled.
840  *
841  * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH: Join a mesh. The mesh ID must be given, and initial
842  *	mesh config parameters may be given.
843  * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_MESH: Leave the mesh network -- no special arguments, the
844  *	network is determined by the network interface.
845  *
846  * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DEAUTHENTICATE: Unprotected deauthentication frame
847  *	notification. This event is used to indicate that an unprotected
848  *	deauthentication frame was dropped when MFP is in use.
849  * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DISASSOCIATE: Unprotected disassociation frame
850  *	notification. This event is used to indicate that an unprotected
851  *	disassociation frame was dropped when MFP is in use.
852  *
853  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE: Notification on the reception of a
854  *      beacon or probe response from a compatible mesh peer.  This is only
855  *      sent while no station information (sta_info) exists for the new peer
856  *      candidate and when @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH,
857  *      @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE, or
858  *      @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM is set.  On reception of this
859  *      notification, userspace may decide to create a new station
860  *      (@NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION).  To stop this notification from
861  *      reoccurring, the userspace authentication daemon may want to create the
862  *      new station with the AUTHENTICATED flag unset and maybe change it later
863  *      depending on the authentication result.
864  *
865  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN: get Wake-on-Wireless-LAN (WoWLAN) settings.
866  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN: set Wake-on-Wireless-LAN (WoWLAN) settings.
867  *	Since wireless is more complex than wired ethernet, it supports
868  *	various triggers. These triggers can be configured through this
869  *	command with the %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS attribute. For
870  *	more background information, see
871  *	https://wireless.wiki.kernel.org/en/users/Documentation/WoWLAN.
872  *	The @NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN command can also be used as a notification
873  *	from the driver reporting the wakeup reason. In this case, the
874  *	@NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS attribute will contain the reason
875  *	for the wakeup, if it was caused by wireless. If it is not present
876  *	in the wakeup notification, the wireless device didn't cause the
877  *	wakeup but reports that it was woken up.
878  *
879  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_REKEY_OFFLOAD: This command is used give the driver
880  *	the necessary information for supporting GTK rekey offload. This
881  *	feature is typically used during WoWLAN. The configuration data
882  *	is contained in %NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA (which is nested and
883  *	contains the data in sub-attributes). After rekeying happened,
884  *	this command may also be sent by the driver as an MLME event to
885  *	inform userspace of the new replay counter.
886  *
887  * @NL80211_CMD_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: This is used as an event to inform userspace
888  *	of PMKSA caching candidates.
889  *
890  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER: Perform a high-level TDLS command (e.g. link setup).
891  *	In addition, this can be used as an event to request userspace to take
892  *	actions on TDLS links (set up a new link or tear down an existing one).
893  *	In such events, %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION indicates the requested
894  *	operation, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC contains the peer MAC address, and
895  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE the reason code to be used (only with
896  *	%NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN).
897  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT: Send a TDLS management frame. The
898  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION attribute determines the type of frame to be
899  *	sent. Public Action codes (802.11-2012 8.1.5.1) will be sent as
900  *	802.11 management frames, while TDLS action codes (802.11-2012
901  *	8.5.13.1) will be encapsulated and sent as data frames. The currently
902  *	supported Public Action code is %WLAN_PUB_ACTION_TDLS_DISCOVER_RES
903  *	and the currently supported TDLS actions codes are given in
904  *	&enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode.
905  *
906  * @NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME: Used by an application controlling an AP
907  *	(or GO) interface (i.e. hostapd) to ask for unexpected frames to
908  *	implement sending deauth to stations that send unexpected class 3
909  *	frames. Also used as the event sent by the kernel when such a frame
910  *	is received.
911  *	For the event, the %NL80211_ATTR_MAC attribute carries the TA and
912  *	other attributes like the interface index are present.
913  *	If used as the command it must have an interface index and you can
914  *	only unsubscribe from the event by closing the socket. Subscription
915  *	is also for %NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME events.
916  *
917  * @NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME: Sent as an event indicating that the
918  *	associated station identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC sent a 4addr frame
919  *	and wasn't already in a 4-addr VLAN. The event will be sent similarly
920  *	to the %NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME event, to the same listener.
921  *
922  * @NL80211_CMD_PROBE_CLIENT: Probe an associated station on an AP interface
923  *	by sending a null data frame to it and reporting when the frame is
924  *	acknowledged. This is used to allow timing out inactive clients. Uses
925  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. The command returns a
926  *	direct reply with an %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE that is later used to match
927  *	up the event with the request. The event includes the same data and
928  *	has %NL80211_ATTR_ACK set if the frame was ACKed.
929  *
930  * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_BEACONS: Register this socket to receive beacons from
931  *	other BSSes when any interfaces are in AP mode. This helps implement
932  *	OLBC handling in hostapd. Beacons are reported in %NL80211_CMD_FRAME
933  *	messages. Note that per PHY only one application may register.
934  *
935  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_NOACK_MAP: sets a bitmap for the individual TIDs whether
936  *      No Acknowledgement Policy should be applied.
937  *
938  * @NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_NOTIFY: An AP or GO may decide to switch channels
939  *	independently of the userspace SME, send this event indicating
940  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is now on %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the
941  *	attributes determining channel width.  This indication may also be
942  *	sent when a remotely-initiated switch (e.g., when a STA receives a CSA
943  *	from the remote AP) is completed;
944  *
945  * @NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_STARTED_NOTIFY: Notify that a channel switch
946  *	has been started on an interface, regardless of the initiator
947  *	(ie. whether it was requested from a remote device or
948  *	initiated on our own).  It indicates that
949  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX will be on %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
950  *	after %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT TBTT's.  The userspace may
951  *	decide to react to this indication by requesting other
952  *	interfaces to change channel as well.
953  *
954  * @NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE: Start the given P2P Device, identified by
955  *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV identifier. It must have been created with
956  *	%NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE previously. After it has been started, the
957  *	P2P Device can be used for P2P operations, e.g. remain-on-channel and
958  *	public action frame TX.
959  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE: Stop the given P2P Device, identified by
960  *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV identifier.
961  *
962  * @NL80211_CMD_CONN_FAILED: connection request to an AP failed; used to
963  *	notify userspace that AP has rejected the connection request from a
964  *	station, due to particular reason. %NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON
965  *	is used for this.
966  *
967  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MCAST_RATE: Change the rate used to send multicast frames
968  *	for IBSS or MESH vif.
969  *
970  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL: sets ACL for MAC address based access control.
971  *	This is to be used with the drivers advertising the support of MAC
972  *	address based access control. List of MAC addresses is passed in
973  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS and ACL policy is passed in
974  *	%NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY. Driver will enable ACL with this list, if it
975  *	is not already done. The new list will replace any existing list. Driver
976  *	will clear its ACL when the list of MAC addresses passed is empty. This
977  *	command is used in AP/P2P GO mode. Driver has to make sure to clear its
978  *	ACL list during %NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP.
979  *
980  * @NL80211_CMD_RADAR_DETECT: Start a Channel availability check (CAC). Once
981  *	a radar is detected or the channel availability scan (CAC) has finished
982  *	or was aborted, or a radar was detected, usermode will be notified with
983  *	this event. This command is also used to notify userspace about radars
984  *	while operating on this channel.
985  *	%NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT is used to inform about the type of the
986  *	event.
987  *
988  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: Get global nl80211 protocol features,
989  *	i.e. features for the nl80211 protocol rather than device features.
990  *	Returns the features in the %NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES bitmap.
991  *
992  * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_FT_IES: Pass down the most up-to-date Fast Transition
993  *	Information Element to the WLAN driver
994  *
995  * @NL80211_CMD_FT_EVENT: Send a Fast transition event from the WLAN driver
996  *	to the supplicant. This will carry the target AP's MAC address along
997  *	with the relevant Information Elements. This event is used to report
998  *	received FT IEs (MDIE, FTIE, RSN IE, TIE, RICIE).
999  *
1000  * @NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_START: Indicates user-space will start running
1001  *	a critical protocol that needs more reliability in the connection to
1002  *	complete.
1003  *
1004  * @NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_STOP: Indicates the connection reliability can
1005  *	return back to normal.
1006  *
1007  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_COALESCE: Get currently supported coalesce rules.
1008  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_COALESCE: Configure coalesce rules or clear existing rules.
1009  *
1010  * @NL80211_CMD_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Perform a channel switch by announcing the
1011  *	new channel information (Channel Switch Announcement - CSA)
1012  *	in the beacon for some time (as defined in the
1013  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT parameter) and then change to the
1014  *	new channel. Userspace provides the new channel information (using
1015  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the attributes determining channel
1016  *	width). %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX may be supplied to inform
1017  *	other station that transmission must be blocked until the channel
1018  *	switch is complete.
1019  *
1020  * @NL80211_CMD_VENDOR: Vendor-specified command/event. The command is specified
1021  *	by the %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID attribute and a sub-command in
1022  *	%NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD. Parameter(s) can be transported in
1023  *	%NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA.
1024  *	For feature advertisement, the %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute is
1025  *	used in the wiphy data as a nested attribute containing descriptions
1026  *	(&struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info) of the supported vendor commands.
1027  *	This may also be sent as an event with the same attributes.
1028  *
1029  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_QOS_MAP: Set Interworking QoS mapping for IP DSCP values.
1030  *	The QoS mapping information is included in %NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP. If
1031  *	that attribute is not included, QoS mapping is disabled. Since this
1032  *	QoS mapping is relevant for IP packets, it is only valid during an
1033  *	association. This is cleared on disassociation and AP restart.
1034  *
1035  * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS: Ask the kernel to add a traffic stream for the given
1036  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TSID and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC with %NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO
1037  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME parameters.
1038  *	Note that the action frame handshake with the AP shall be handled by
1039  *	userspace via the normal management RX/TX framework, this only sets
1040  *	up the TX TS in the driver/device.
1041  *	If the admitted time attribute is not added then the request just checks
1042  *	if a subsequent setup could be successful, the intent is to use this to
1043  *	avoid setting up a session with the AP when local restrictions would
1044  *	make that impossible. However, the subsequent "real" setup may still
1045  *	fail even if the check was successful.
1046  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_TX_TS: Remove an existing TS with the %NL80211_ATTR_TSID
1047  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC parameters. It isn't necessary to call this
1048  *	before removing a station entry entirely, or before disassociating
1049  *	or similar, cleanup will happen in the driver/device in this case.
1050  *
1051  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MPP: Get mesh path attributes for mesh proxy path to
1052  *	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
1053  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
1054  *
1055  * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_OCB: Join the OCB network. The center frequency and
1056  *	bandwidth of a channel must be given.
1057  * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_OCB: Leave the OCB network -- no special arguments, the
1058  *	network is determined by the network interface.
1059  *
1060  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer,
1061  *	identified by the %NL80211_ATTR_MAC parameter. A target channel is
1062  *	provided via %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and other attributes determining
1063  *	channel width/type. The target operating class is given via
1064  *	%NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS.
1065  *	The driver is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching
1066  *	operations and returning to the base channel for communication with the
1067  *	AP.
1068  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CANCEL_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS
1069  *	peer given by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. Both peers must be on the base channel
1070  *	when this command completes.
1071  *
1072  * @NL80211_CMD_WIPHY_REG_CHANGE: Similar to %NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE, but used
1073  *	as an event to indicate changes for devices with wiphy-specific regdom
1074  *	management.
1075  *
1076  * @NL80211_CMD_ABORT_SCAN: Stop an ongoing scan. Returns -ENOENT if a scan is
1077  *	not running. The driver indicates the status of the scan through
1078  *	cfg80211_scan_done().
1079  *
1080  * @NL80211_CMD_START_NAN: Start NAN operation, identified by its
1081  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WDEV interface. This interface must have been
1082  *	previously created with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE. After it
1083  *	has been started, the NAN interface will create or join a
1084  *	cluster. This command must have a valid
1085  *	%NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF attribute and optional
1086  *	%NL80211_ATTR_BANDS attributes.  If %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS is
1087  *	omitted or set to 0, it means don't-care and the device will
1088  *	decide what to use.  After this command NAN functions can be
1089  *	added.
1090  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_NAN: Stop the NAN operation, identified by
1091  *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV interface.
1092  * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_NAN_FUNCTION: Add a NAN function. The function is defined
1093  *	with %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC nested attribute. When called, this
1094  *	operation returns the strictly positive and unique instance id
1095  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC_INST_ID) and a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE)
1096  *	of the function upon success.
1097  *	Since instance ID's can be re-used, this cookie is the right
1098  *	way to identify the function. This will avoid races when a termination
1099  *	event is handled by the user space after it has already added a new
1100  *	function that got the same instance id from the kernel as the one
1101  *	which just terminated.
1102  *	This cookie may be used in NAN events even before the command
1103  *	returns, so userspace shouldn't process NAN events until it processes
1104  *	the response to this command.
1105  *	Look at %NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER as well.
1106  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_NAN_FUNCTION: Delete a NAN function by cookie.
1107  *	This command is also used as a notification sent when a NAN function is
1108  *	terminated. This will contain a %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC_INST_ID
1109  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE attributes.
1110  * @NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG: Change current NAN
1111  *	configuration. NAN must be operational (%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN
1112  *	was executed).  It must contain at least one of the following
1113  *	attributes: %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF,
1114  *	%NL80211_ATTR_BANDS.  If %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS is omitted, the
1115  *	current configuration is not changed.  If it is present but
1116  *	set to zero, the configuration is changed to don't-care
1117  *	(i.e. the device can decide what to do).
1118  * @NL80211_CMD_NAN_MATCH: Notification sent when a match is reported.
1119  *	This will contain a %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH nested attribute and
1120  *	%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE.
1121  *
1122  * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS: Update one or more connect parameters
1123  *	for subsequent roaming cases if the driver or firmware uses internal
1124  *	BSS selection. This command can be issued only while connected and it
1125  *	does not result in a change for the current association. Currently,
1126  *	only the %NL80211_ATTR_IE data is used and updated with this command.
1127  *
1128  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK: For offloaded 4-Way handshake, set the PMK or PMK-R0
1129  *	for the given authenticator address (specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MAC).
1130  *	When %NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME is set, %NL80211_ATTR_PMK specifies the
1131  *	PMK-R0, otherwise it specifies the PMK.
1132  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMK: For offloaded 4-Way handshake, delete the previously
1133  *	configured PMK for the authenticator address identified by
1134  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC.
1135  * @NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED: An event that indicates port is authorized and
1136  *	open for regular data traffic. For STA/P2P-client, this event is sent
1137  *	with AP MAC address and for AP/P2P-GO, the event carries the STA/P2P-
1138  *	client MAC address.
1139  *	Drivers that support 4 way handshake offload should send this event for
1140  *	STA/P2P-client after successful 4-way HS or after 802.1X FT following
1141  *	NL80211_CMD_CONNECT or NL80211_CMD_ROAM. Drivers using AP/P2P-GO 4-way
1142  *	handshake offload should send this event on successful completion of
1143  *	4-way handshake with the peer (STA/P2P-client).
1144  * @NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME: Control Port (e.g. PAE) frame TX request
1145  *	and RX notification.  This command is used both as a request to transmit
1146  *	a control port frame and as a notification that a control port frame
1147  *	has been received. %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the
1148  *	frame contents.  The frame is the raw EAPoL data, without ethernet or
1149  *	802.11 headers.
1150  *	For an MLD transmitter, the %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID may be given and
1151  *	its effect will depend on the destination: If the destination is known
1152  *	to be an MLD, this will be used as a hint to select the link to transmit
1153  *	the frame on. If the destination is not an MLD, this will select both
1154  *	the link to transmit on and the source address will be set to the link
1155  *	address of that link.
1156  *	When used as an event indication %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
1157  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC are added
1158  *	indicating the protocol type of the received frame; whether the frame
1159  *	was received unencrypted and the MAC address of the peer respectively.
1160  *
1161  * @NL80211_CMD_RELOAD_REGDB: Request that the regdb firmware file is reloaded.
1162  *
1163  * @NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH: This interface is exclusively defined for host
1164  *	drivers that do not define separate commands for authentication and
1165  *	association, but rely on user space for the authentication to happen.
1166  *	This interface acts both as the event request (driver to user space)
1167  *	to trigger the authentication and command response (userspace to
1168  *	driver) to indicate the authentication status.
1169  *
1170  *	User space uses the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT command to the host driver to
1171  *	trigger a connection. The host driver selects a BSS and further uses
1172  *	this interface to offload only the authentication part to the user
1173  *	space. Authentication frames are passed between the driver and user
1174  *	space through the %NL80211_CMD_FRAME interface. Host driver proceeds
1175  *	further with the association after getting successful authentication
1176  *	status. User space indicates the authentication status through
1177  *	%NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE attribute in %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH
1178  *	command interface.
1179  *
1180  *	Host driver sends MLD address of the AP with %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR in
1181  *	%NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH event to indicate user space to enable MLO
1182  *	during the authentication offload in STA mode while connecting to MLD
1183  *	APs. Host driver should check %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT flag capability
1184  *	in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to know whether the user space supports enabling
1185  *	MLO during the authentication offload or not.
1186  *	User space should enable MLO during the authentication only when it
1187  *	receives the AP MLD address in authentication offload request. User
1188  *	space shouldn't enable MLO when the authentication offload request
1189  *	doesn't indicate the AP MLD address even if the AP is MLO capable.
1190  *	User space should use %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR as peer's MLD address and
1191  *	interface address identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX as self MLD
1192  *	address. User space and host driver to use MLD addresses in RA, TA and
1193  *	BSSID fields of the frames between them, and host driver translates the
1194  *	MLD addresses to/from link addresses based on the link chosen for the
1195  *	authentication.
1196  *
1197  *	Host driver reports this status on an authentication failure to the
1198  *	user space through the connect result as the user space would have
1199  *	initiated the connection through the connect request.
1200  *
1201  * @NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED: An event that notify station's
1202  *	ht opmode or vht opmode changes using any of %NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE,
1203  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH,%NL80211_ATTR_NSS attributes with its
1204  *	address(specified in %NL80211_ATTR_MAC).
1205  *
1206  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, in
1207  *	the %NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS attribute.
1208  *
1209  * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_START: start a (set of) peer measurement(s)
1210  *	with the given parameters, which are encapsulated in the nested
1211  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS attribute. Optionally, MAC address
1212  *	randomization may be enabled and configured by specifying the
1213  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK attributes.
1214  *	If a timeout is requested, use the %NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT attribute.
1215  *	A u64 cookie for further %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE use is returned in
1216  *	the netlink extended ack message.
1217  *
1218  *	To cancel a measurement, close the socket that requested it.
1219  *
1220  *	Measurement results are reported to the socket that requested the
1221  *	measurement using @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT when they
1222  *	become available, so applications must ensure a large enough socket
1223  *	buffer size.
1224  *
1225  *	Depending on driver support it may or may not be possible to start
1226  *	multiple concurrent measurements.
1227  * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT: This command number is used for the
1228  *	result notification from the driver to the requesting socket.
1229  * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_COMPLETE: Notification only, indicating that
1230  *	the measurement completed, using the measurement cookie
1231  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE).
1232  *
1233  * @NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_RADAR: Notify the kernel that a radar signal was
1234  *	detected and reported by a neighboring device on the channel
1235  *	indicated by %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and other attributes
1236  *	determining the width and type.
1237  *
1238  * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_OWE_INFO: This interface allows the host driver to
1239  *	offload OWE processing to user space. This intends to support
1240  *	OWE AKM by the host drivers that implement SME but rely
1241  *	on the user space for the cryptographic/DH IE processing in AP mode.
1242  *
1243  * @NL80211_CMD_PROBE_MESH_LINK: The requirement for mesh link metric
1244  *	refreshing, is that from one mesh point we be able to send some data
1245  *	frames to other mesh points which are not currently selected as a
1246  *	primary traffic path, but which are only 1 hop away. The absence of
1247  *	the primary path to the chosen node makes it necessary to apply some
1248  *	form of marking on a chosen packet stream so that the packets can be
1249  *	properly steered to the selected node for testing, and not by the
1250  *	regular mesh path lookup. Further, the packets must be of type data
1251  *	so that the rate control (often embedded in firmware) is used for
1252  *	rate selection.
1253  *
1254  *	Here attribute %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is used to specify connected mesh
1255  *	peer MAC address and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the frame
1256  *	content. The frame is ethernet data.
1257  *
1258  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG: Data frame TID specific configuration
1259  *	is passed using %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG attribute.
1260  *
1261  * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_BEACON: Unprotected or incorrectly protected Beacon
1262  *	frame. This event is used to indicate that a received Beacon frame was
1263  *	dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while beacon
1264  *	protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode).
1265  *
1266  * @NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME_TX_STATUS: Report TX status of a control
1267  *	port frame transmitted with %NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME.
1268  *	%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE identifies the TX command and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME
1269  *	includes the contents of the frame. %NL80211_ATTR_ACK flag is included
1270  *	if the recipient acknowledged the frame.
1271  *
1272  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS: SAR power limitation configuration is
1273  *	passed using %NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY is used to
1274  *	specify the wiphy index to be applied to.
1275  *
1276  * @NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION: This notification is sent out whenever
1277  *	mac80211/drv detects a bss color collision.
1278  *
1279  * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_REQUEST: This command is used to indicate that
1280  *	userspace wants to change the BSS color.
1281  *
1282  * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED: Notify userland, that a color change has
1283  *	started
1284  *
1285  * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED: Notify userland, that the color change has
1286  *	been aborted
1287  *
1288  * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED: Notify userland that the color change
1289  *	has completed
1290  *
1291  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD: Set FILS AAD data to the driver using -
1292  *	&NL80211_ATTR_MAC - for STA MAC address
1293  *	&NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - for KEK
1294  *	&NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES - for FILS Nonces
1295  *		(STA Nonce 16 bytes followed by AP Nonce 16 bytes)
1296  *
1297  * @NL80211_CMD_ASSOC_COMEBACK: notification about an association
1298  *      temporal rejection with comeback. The event includes %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
1299  *      to describe the BSSID address of the AP and %NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT to
1300  *      specify the timeout value.
1301  *
1302  * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK: Add a new link to an interface. The
1303  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID attribute is used for the new link.
1304  * @NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK: Remove a link from an interface. This may come
1305  *	without %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID as an easy way to remove all links
1306  *	in preparation for e.g. roaming to a regular (non-MLO) AP.
1307  *
1308  * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK_STA: Add a link to an MLD station
1309  * @NL80211_CMD_MODIFY_LINK_STA: Modify a link of an MLD station
1310  * @NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK_STA: Remove a link of an MLD station
1311  *
1312  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_HW_TIMESTAMP: Enable/disable HW timestamping of Timing
1313  *	measurement and Fine timing measurement frames. If %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
1314  *	is included, enable/disable HW timestamping only for frames to/from the
1315  *	specified MAC address. Otherwise enable/disable HW timestamping for
1316  *	all TM/FTM frames (including ones that were enabled with specific MAC
1317  *	address). If %NL80211_ATTR_HW_TIMESTAMP_ENABLED is not included, disable
1318  *	HW timestamping.
1319  *	The number of peers that HW timestamping can be enabled for concurrently
1320  *	is indicated by %NL80211_ATTR_MAX_HW_TIMESTAMP_PEERS.
1321  *
1322  * @NL80211_CMD_LINKS_REMOVED: Notify userspace about the removal of STA MLD
1323  *	setup links due to AP MLD removing the corresponding affiliated APs with
1324  *	Multi-Link reconfiguration. %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS is used to provide
1325  *	information about the removed STA MLD setup links.
1326  *
1327  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_TO_LINK_MAPPING: Set the TID to Link Mapping for a
1328  *      non-AP MLD station. The %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_TTLM_DLINK and
1329  *      %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_TTLM_ULINK attributes are used to specify the
1330  *      TID to Link mapping for downlink/uplink traffic.
1331  *
1332  * @NL80211_CMD_ASSOC_MLO_RECONF: For a non-AP MLD station, request to
1333  *      add/remove links to/from the association.
1334  *
1335  * @NL80211_CMD_EPCS_CFG: EPCS configuration for a station. Used by userland to
1336  *	control EPCS configuration. Used to notify userland on the current state
1337  *	of EPCS.
1338  *
1339  * @NL80211_CMD_MAX: highest used command number
1340  * @__NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST: internal use
1341  */
1342 enum nl80211_commands {
1343 /* don't change the order or add anything between, this is ABI! */
1344 	NL80211_CMD_UNSPEC,
1345 
1346 	NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY,		/* can dump */
1347 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY,
1348 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_WIPHY,
1349 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_WIPHY,
1350 
1351 	NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE,	/* can dump */
1352 	NL80211_CMD_SET_INTERFACE,
1353 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE,
1354 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_INTERFACE,
1355 
1356 	NL80211_CMD_GET_KEY,
1357 	NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY,
1358 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY,
1359 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_KEY,
1360 
1361 	NL80211_CMD_GET_BEACON,
1362 	NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON,
1363 	NL80211_CMD_START_AP,
1364 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON = NL80211_CMD_START_AP,
1365 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP,
1366 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_BEACON = NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP,
1367 
1368 	NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION,
1369 	NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION,
1370 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION,
1371 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_STATION,
1372 
1373 	NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH,
1374 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MPATH,
1375 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_MPATH,
1376 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_MPATH,
1377 
1378 	NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS,
1379 
1380 	NL80211_CMD_SET_REG,
1381 	NL80211_CMD_REQ_SET_REG,
1382 
1383 	NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG,
1384 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG,
1385 
1386 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE /* reserved; not used */,
1387 
1388 	NL80211_CMD_GET_REG,
1389 
1390 	NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN,
1391 	NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN,
1392 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_SCAN_RESULTS,
1393 	NL80211_CMD_SCAN_ABORTED,
1394 
1395 	NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE,
1396 
1397 	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE,
1398 	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE,
1399 	NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1400 	NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE,
1401 
1402 	NL80211_CMD_MICHAEL_MIC_FAILURE,
1403 
1404 	NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT,
1405 
1406 	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS,
1407 	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_IBSS,
1408 
1409 	NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
1410 
1411 	NL80211_CMD_CONNECT,
1412 	NL80211_CMD_ROAM,
1413 	NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT,
1414 
1415 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY_NETNS,
1416 
1417 	NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY,
1418 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_SURVEY_RESULTS,
1419 
1420 	NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA,
1421 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA,
1422 	NL80211_CMD_FLUSH_PMKSA,
1423 
1424 	NL80211_CMD_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL,
1425 	NL80211_CMD_CANCEL_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL,
1426 
1427 	NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK,
1428 
1429 	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME,
1430 	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_ACTION = NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME,
1431 	NL80211_CMD_FRAME,
1432 	NL80211_CMD_ACTION = NL80211_CMD_FRAME,
1433 	NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
1434 	NL80211_CMD_ACTION_TX_STATUS = NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
1435 
1436 	NL80211_CMD_SET_POWER_SAVE,
1437 	NL80211_CMD_GET_POWER_SAVE,
1438 
1439 	NL80211_CMD_SET_CQM,
1440 	NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM,
1441 
1442 	NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL,
1443 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WDS_PEER,
1444 
1445 	NL80211_CMD_FRAME_WAIT_CANCEL,
1446 
1447 	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH,
1448 	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_MESH,
1449 
1450 	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1451 	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DISASSOCIATE,
1452 
1453 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE,
1454 
1455 	NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN,
1456 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN,
1457 
1458 	NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN,
1459 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN,
1460 	NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_RESULTS,
1461 	NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED,
1462 
1463 	NL80211_CMD_SET_REKEY_OFFLOAD,
1464 
1465 	NL80211_CMD_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
1466 
1467 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER,
1468 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT,
1469 
1470 	NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME,
1471 
1472 	NL80211_CMD_PROBE_CLIENT,
1473 
1474 	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_BEACONS,
1475 
1476 	NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME,
1477 
1478 	NL80211_CMD_SET_NOACK_MAP,
1479 
1480 	NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_NOTIFY,
1481 
1482 	NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE,
1483 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE,
1484 
1485 	NL80211_CMD_CONN_FAILED,
1486 
1487 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MCAST_RATE,
1488 
1489 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL,
1490 
1491 	NL80211_CMD_RADAR_DETECT,
1492 
1493 	NL80211_CMD_GET_PROTOCOL_FEATURES,
1494 
1495 	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_FT_IES,
1496 	NL80211_CMD_FT_EVENT,
1497 
1498 	NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_START,
1499 	NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_STOP,
1500 
1501 	NL80211_CMD_GET_COALESCE,
1502 	NL80211_CMD_SET_COALESCE,
1503 
1504 	NL80211_CMD_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1505 
1506 	NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
1507 
1508 	NL80211_CMD_SET_QOS_MAP,
1509 
1510 	NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS,
1511 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_TX_TS,
1512 
1513 	NL80211_CMD_GET_MPP,
1514 
1515 	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_OCB,
1516 	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_OCB,
1517 
1518 	NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_STARTED_NOTIFY,
1519 
1520 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1521 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CANCEL_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1522 
1523 	NL80211_CMD_WIPHY_REG_CHANGE,
1524 
1525 	NL80211_CMD_ABORT_SCAN,
1526 
1527 	NL80211_CMD_START_NAN,
1528 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_NAN,
1529 	NL80211_CMD_ADD_NAN_FUNCTION,
1530 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_NAN_FUNCTION,
1531 	NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG,
1532 	NL80211_CMD_NAN_MATCH,
1533 
1534 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST,
1535 
1536 	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS,
1537 
1538 	NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK,
1539 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMK,
1540 
1541 	NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED,
1542 
1543 	NL80211_CMD_RELOAD_REGDB,
1544 
1545 	NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH,
1546 
1547 	NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED,
1548 
1549 	NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME,
1550 
1551 	NL80211_CMD_GET_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS,
1552 
1553 	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_START,
1554 	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT,
1555 	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_COMPLETE,
1556 
1557 	NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_RADAR,
1558 
1559 	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_OWE_INFO,
1560 
1561 	NL80211_CMD_PROBE_MESH_LINK,
1562 
1563 	NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG,
1564 
1565 	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_BEACON,
1566 
1567 	NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
1568 
1569 	NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS,
1570 
1571 	NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION,
1572 
1573 	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_REQUEST,
1574 
1575 	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED,
1576 	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED,
1577 	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED,
1578 
1579 	NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD,
1580 
1581 	NL80211_CMD_ASSOC_COMEBACK,
1582 
1583 	NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK,
1584 	NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK,
1585 
1586 	NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK_STA,
1587 	NL80211_CMD_MODIFY_LINK_STA,
1588 	NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK_STA,
1589 
1590 	NL80211_CMD_SET_HW_TIMESTAMP,
1591 
1592 	NL80211_CMD_LINKS_REMOVED,
1593 
1594 	NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_TO_LINK_MAPPING,
1595 
1596 	NL80211_CMD_ASSOC_MLO_RECONF,
1597 	NL80211_CMD_EPCS_CFG,
1598 
1599 	/* add new commands above here */
1600 
1601 	/* used to define NL80211_CMD_MAX below */
1602 	__NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST,
1603 	NL80211_CMD_MAX = __NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST - 1
1604 };
1605 
1606 /*
1607  * Allow user space programs to use #ifdef on new commands by defining them
1608  * here
1609  */
1610 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS
1611 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE
1612 #define NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE
1613 #define NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE
1614 #define NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE
1615 #define NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE
1616 #define NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE
1617 #define NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT
1618 
1619 #define NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS
1620 
1621 /* source-level API compatibility */
1622 #define NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG
1623 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG
1624 #define NL80211_MESH_SETUP_VENDOR_PATH_SEL_IE NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE
1625 
1626 /**
1627  * enum nl80211_attrs - nl80211 netlink attributes
1628  *
1629  * @NL80211_ATTR_UNSPEC: unspecified attribute to catch errors
1630  *
1631  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY: index of wiphy to operate on, cf.
1632  *	/sys/class/ieee80211/<phyname>/index
1633  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME: wiphy name (used for renaming)
1634  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS: a nested array of TX queue parameters
1635  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ: frequency of the selected channel in MHz,
1636  *	defines the channel together with the (deprecated)
1637  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE attribute or the attributes
1638  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH and if needed %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
1639  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2
1640  * @NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH: u32 attribute containing one of the values
1641  *	of &enum nl80211_chan_width, describing the channel width. See the
1642  *	documentation of the enum for more information.
1643  * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1: Center frequency of the first part of the
1644  *	channel, used for anything but 20 MHz bandwidth. In S1G this is the
1645  *	operating channel center frequency.
1646  * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2: Center frequency of the second part of the
1647  *	channel, used only for 80+80 MHz bandwidth
1648  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE: included with NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
1649  *	if HT20 or HT40 are to be used (i.e., HT disabled if not included):
1650  *	NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT = HT not allowed (i.e., same as not including
1651  *		this attribute)
1652  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT20 = HT20 only
1653  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS = secondary channel is below the primary channel
1654  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS = secondary channel is above the primary channel
1655  *	This attribute is now deprecated.
1656  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT: TX retry limit for frames whose length is
1657  *	less than or equal to the RTS threshold; allowed range: 1..255;
1658  *	dot11ShortRetryLimit; u8
1659  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG: TX retry limit for frames whose length is
1660  *	greater than the RTS threshold; allowed range: 1..255;
1661  *	dot11ShortLongLimit; u8
1662  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD: fragmentation threshold, i.e., maximum
1663  *	length in octets for frames; allowed range: 256..8000, disable
1664  *	fragmentation with (u32)-1; dot11FragmentationThreshold; u32
1665  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD: RTS threshold (TX frames with length
1666  *	larger than or equal to this use RTS/CTS handshake); allowed range:
1667  *	0..65536, disable with (u32)-1; dot11RTSThreshold; u32
1668  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_COVERAGE_CLASS: Coverage Class as defined by IEEE 802.11
1669  *	section 7.3.2.9; dot11CoverageClass; u8
1670  *
1671  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX: network interface index of the device to operate on
1672  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME: network interface name
1673  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE: type of virtual interface, see &enum nl80211_iftype
1674  *
1675  * @NL80211_ATTR_WDEV: wireless device identifier, used for pseudo-devices
1676  *	that don't have a netdev (u64)
1677  *
1678  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC: MAC address (various uses)
1679  *
1680  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA: (temporal) key data; for TKIP this consists of
1681  *	16 bytes encryption key followed by 8 bytes each for TX and RX MIC
1682  *	keys
1683  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX: key ID (u8, 0-3)
1684  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER: key cipher suite (u32, as defined by IEEE 802.11
1685  *	section 7.3.2.25.1, e.g. 0x000FAC04)
1686  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ: transmit key sequence number (IV/PN) for TKIP and
1687  *	CCMP keys, each six bytes in little endian
1688  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT: Flag attribute indicating the key is default key
1689  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT: Flag attribute indicating the key is the
1690  *	default management key
1691  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE: For crypto settings for connect or
1692  *	other commands, indicates which pairwise cipher suites are used
1693  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP: For crypto settings for connect or
1694  *	other commands, indicates which group cipher suite is used
1695  *
1696  * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL: beacon interval in TU
1697  * @NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD: DTIM period for beaconing
1698  * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD: portion of the beacon before the TIM IE
1699  * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL: portion of the beacon after the TIM IE
1700  *
1701  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID: Association ID for the station (u16)
1702  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS: flags, nested element with NLA_FLAG attributes of
1703  *	&enum nl80211_sta_flags (deprecated, use %NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2)
1704  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_LISTEN_INTERVAL: listen interval as defined by
1705  *	IEEE 802.11 7.3.1.6 (u16).
1706  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_RATES: supported rates, array of supported
1707  *	rates as defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but without the length
1708  *	restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
1709  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN: interface index of VLAN interface to move station
1710  *	to, or the AP interface the station was originally added to.
1711  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO: information about a station, part of station info
1712  *	given for %NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION, nested attribute containing
1713  *	info as possible, see &enum nl80211_sta_info.
1714  *
1715  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_BANDS: Information about an operating bands,
1716  *	consisting of a nested array.
1717  *
1718  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_ID: mesh id (1-32 bytes).
1719  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_ACTION: action to perform on the mesh peer link
1720  *	(see &enum nl80211_plink_action).
1721  * @NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP: MAC address of the next hop for a mesh path.
1722  * @NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO: information about a mesh_path, part of mesh path
1723  *	info given for %NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH, nested attribute described at
1724  *	&enum nl80211_mpath_info.
1725  *
1726  * @NL80211_ATTR_MNTR_FLAGS: flags, nested element with NLA_FLAG attributes of
1727  *      &enum nl80211_mntr_flags.
1728  *
1729  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2: an ISO-3166-alpha2 country code for which the
1730  *	current regulatory domain should be set to or is already set to.
1731  *	For example, 'CR', for Costa Rica. This attribute is used by the kernel
1732  *	to query the CRDA to retrieve one regulatory domain. This attribute can
1733  *	also be used by userspace to query the kernel for the currently set
1734  *	regulatory domain. We chose an alpha2 as that is also used by the
1735  *	IEEE-802.11 country information element to identify a country.
1736  *	Users can also simply ask the wireless core to set regulatory domain
1737  *	to a specific alpha2.
1738  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULES: a nested array of regulatory domain regulatory
1739  *	rules.
1740  *
1741  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled (u8, 0 or 1)
1742  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled
1743  *	(u8, 0 or 1)
1744  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time enabled
1745  *	(u8, 0 or 1)
1746  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES: basic rates, array of basic
1747  *	rates in format defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but without the length
1748  *	restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
1749  *
1750  * @NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY: HT Capability information element (from
1751  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
1752  *
1753  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing all
1754  *	supported interface types, each a flag attribute with the number
1755  *	of the interface mode.
1756  *
1757  * @NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE: Management frame subtype for
1758  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE.
1759  *
1760  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE: Information element(s) data (used, e.g., with
1761  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE).
1762  *
1763  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCAN_SSIDS: number of SSIDs you can scan with
1764  *	a single scan request, a wiphy attribute.
1765  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_SSIDS: number of SSIDs you can
1766  *	scan with a single scheduled scan request, a wiphy attribute.
1767  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_IE_LEN: maximum length of information elements
1768  *	that can be added to a scan request
1769  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCHED_SCAN_IE_LEN: maximum length of information
1770  *	elements that can be added to a scheduled scan request
1771  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_MATCH_SETS: maximum number of sets that can be
1772  *	used with @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH, a wiphy attribute.
1773  *
1774  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES: nested attribute with frequencies (in MHz)
1775  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS: nested attribute with SSIDs, leave out for passive
1776  *	scanning and include a zero-length SSID (wildcard) for wildcard scan
1777  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS: scan result BSS
1778  *
1779  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR: indicates who requested the regulatory domain
1780  *	currently in effect. This could be any of the %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_*
1781  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE: indicates the type of the regulatory domain currently
1782  *	set. This can be one of the nl80211_reg_type (%NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_*)
1783  *
1784  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_COMMANDS: wiphy attribute that specifies
1785  *	an array of command numbers (i.e. a mapping index to command number)
1786  *	that the driver for the given wiphy supports.
1787  *
1788  * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME: frame data (binary attribute), including frame header
1789  *	and body, but not FCS; used, e.g., with NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE and
1790  *	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE events
1791  * @NL80211_ATTR_SSID: SSID (binary attribute, 0..32 octets)
1792  * @NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE: AuthenticationType, see &enum nl80211_auth_type,
1793  *	represented as a u32
1794  * @NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE: ReasonCode for %NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE and
1795  *	%NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE, u16
1796  *
1797  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE: Key Type, see &enum nl80211_key_type, represented as
1798  *	a u32
1799  *
1800  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE: A channel which has suffered a regulatory change
1801  *	due to considerations from a beacon hint. This attribute reflects
1802  *	the state of the channel _before_ the beacon hint processing. This
1803  *	attributes consists of a nested attribute containing
1804  *	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_*
1805  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER: A channel which has suffered a regulatory change
1806  *	due to considerations from a beacon hint. This attribute reflects
1807  *	the state of the channel _after_ the beacon hint processing. This
1808  *	attributes consists of a nested attribute containing
1809  *	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_*
1810  *
1811  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES: a set of u32 values indicating the supported
1812  *	cipher suites
1813  *
1814  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_FIXED: a flag indicating the IBSS should not try to look
1815  *	for other networks on different channels
1816  *
1817  * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT: a flag indicating than an operation timed out; this
1818  *	is used, e.g., with %NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE event
1819  *
1820  * @NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP: Whether management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) is
1821  *	used for the association (&enum nl80211_mfp, represented as a u32);
1822  *	this attribute can be used with %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and
1823  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests. %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL is not allowed for
1824  *	%NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE since user space SME is expected and hence, it
1825  *	must have decided whether to use management frame protection or not.
1826  *	Setting %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL with a %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT request will
1827  *	let the driver (or the firmware) decide whether to use MFP or not.
1828  *
1829  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2: Attribute containing a
1830  *	&struct nl80211_sta_flag_update.
1831  *
1832  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT: A flag indicating whether user space controls
1833  *	IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED, in
1834  *	station mode. If the flag is included in %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE
1835  *	request, the driver will assume that the port is unauthorized until
1836  *	authorized by user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by
1837  *	default in station mode.
1838  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE: A 16-bit value indicating the
1839  *	ethertype that will be used for key negotiation. It can be
1840  *	specified with the associate and connect commands. If it is not
1841  *	specified, the value defaults to 0x888E (PAE, 802.1X). This
1842  *	attribute is also used as a flag in the wiphy information to
1843  *	indicate that protocols other than PAE are supported.
1844  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT: When included along with
1845  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE, indicates that the custom
1846  *	ethertype frames used for key negotiation must not be encrypted.
1847  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211: A flag indicating whether control
1848  *	port frames (e.g. of type given in %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE)
1849  *	will be sent directly to the network interface or sent via the NL80211
1850  *	socket.  If this attribute is missing, then legacy behavior of sending
1851  *	control port frames directly to the network interface is used.  If the
1852  *	flag is included, then control port frames are sent over NL80211 instead
1853  *	using %CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME.  If control port routing over NL80211 is
1854  *	to be used then userspace must also use the %NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER
1855  *	flag. When used with %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH, pre-auth
1856  *	frames are not forwarded over the control port.
1857  *
1858  * @NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA: Testmode data blob, passed through to the driver.
1859  *	We recommend using nested, driver-specific attributes within this.
1860  *
1861  * @NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP: A flag indicating that the DISCONNECT
1862  *	event was due to the AP disconnecting the station, and not due to
1863  *	a local disconnect request.
1864  * @NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE: StatusCode for the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
1865  *	event (u16)
1866  * @NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY: Flag attribute, used with connect(), indicating
1867  *	that protected APs should be used. This is also used with NEW_BEACON to
1868  *	indicate that the BSS is to use protection.
1869  *
1870  * @NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to
1871  *	indicate which WPA version(s) the AP we want to associate with is using
1872  *	(a u32 with flags from &enum nl80211_wpa_versions).
1873  * @NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to
1874  *	indicate which key management algorithm(s) to use (an array of u32).
1875  *	This attribute is also sent in response to @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY,
1876  *	indicating the supported AKM suites, intended for specific drivers which
1877  *	implement SME and have constraints on which AKMs are supported and also
1878  *	the cases where an AKM support is offloaded to the driver/firmware.
1879  *	If there is no such notification from the driver, user space should
1880  *	assume the driver supports all the AKM suites.
1881  *
1882  * @NL80211_ATTR_REQ_IE: (Re)association request information elements as
1883  *	sent out by the card, for ROAM and successful CONNECT events.
1884  * @NL80211_ATTR_RESP_IE: (Re)association response information elements as
1885  *	sent by peer, for ROAM and successful CONNECT events.
1886  *
1887  * @NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID: previous BSSID, to be used in ASSOCIATE and CONNECT
1888  *	commands to specify a request to reassociate within an ESS, i.e., to use
1889  *	Reassociate Request frame (with the value of this attribute in the
1890  *	Current AP address field) instead of Association Request frame which is
1891  *	used for the initial association to an ESS.
1892  *
1893  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY: key information in a nested attribute with
1894  *	%NL80211_KEY_* sub-attributes
1895  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEYS: array of keys for static WEP keys for connect()
1896  *	and join_ibss(), key information is in a nested attribute each
1897  *	with %NL80211_KEY_* sub-attributes
1898  *
1899  * @NL80211_ATTR_PID: Process ID of a network namespace.
1900  * @NL80211_ATTR_NETNS_FD: File descriptor of a network namespace.
1901  *
1902  * @NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION: Used to indicate consistent snapshots for
1903  *	dumps. This number increases whenever the object list being
1904  *	dumped changes, and as such userspace can verify that it has
1905  *	obtained a complete and consistent snapshot by verifying that
1906  *	all dump messages contain the same generation number. If it
1907  *	changed then the list changed and the dump should be repeated
1908  *	completely from scratch.
1909  *
1910  * @NL80211_ATTR_4ADDR: Use 4-address frames on a virtual interface
1911  *
1912  * @NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO: survey information about a channel, part of
1913  *      the survey response for %NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY, nested attribute
1914  *      containing info as possible, see &enum survey_info.
1915  *
1916  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKID: PMK material for PMKSA caching.
1917  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_PMKIDS: maximum number of PMKIDs a firmware can
1918  *	cache, a wiphy attribute.
1919  *
1920  * @NL80211_ATTR_DURATION: Duration of an operation in milliseconds, u32.
1921  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_DURATION: Device attribute that
1922  *	specifies the maximum duration that can be requested with the
1923  *	remain-on-channel operation, in milliseconds, u32.
1924  *
1925  * @NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE: Generic 64-bit cookie to identify objects.
1926  *
1927  * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES: Nested set of attributes
1928  *	(enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes) describing TX rates per band. The
1929  *	enum nl80211_band value is used as the index (nla_type() of the nested
1930  *	data. If a band is not included, it will be configured to allow all
1931  *	rates based on negotiated supported rates information. This attribute
1932  *	is used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK and with starting AP,
1933  *	and joining mesh networks (not IBSS yet). In the later case, it must
1934  *	specify just a single bitrate, which is to be used for the beacon.
1935  *	The driver must also specify support for this with the extended
1936  *	features NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY,
1937  *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT,
1938  *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT and
1939  *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE.
1940  *
1941  * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_MATCH: A binary attribute which typically must contain
1942  *	at least one byte, currently used with @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME.
1943  * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE: A u16 indicating the frame type/subtype for the
1944  *	@NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME command.
1945  * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_FRAME_TYPES: wiphy capability attribute, which is a
1946  *	nested attribute of %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE attributes, containing
1947  *	information about which frame types can be transmitted with
1948  *	%NL80211_CMD_FRAME.
1949  * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_FRAME_TYPES: wiphy capability attribute, which is a
1950  *	nested attribute of %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE attributes, containing
1951  *	information about which frame types can be registered for RX.
1952  *
1953  * @NL80211_ATTR_ACK: Flag attribute indicating that the frame was
1954  *	acknowledged by the recipient.
1955  * @NL80211_ATTR_ACK_SIGNAL: Station's ack signal strength (s32)
1956  *
1957  * @NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE: powersave state, using &enum nl80211_ps_state values.
1958  *
1959  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM: connection quality monitor configuration in a
1960  *	nested attribute with %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_* sub-attributes.
1961  *
1962  * @NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_STATE_CHANGE: Flag attribute to indicate that a command
1963  *	is requesting a local authentication/association state change without
1964  *	invoking actual management frame exchange. This can be used with
1965  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1966  *	NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE.
1967  *
1968  * @NL80211_ATTR_AP_ISOLATE: (AP mode) Do not forward traffic between stations
1969  *	connected to this BSS.
1970  *
1971  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING: Transmit power setting type. See
1972  *      &enum nl80211_tx_power_setting for possible values.
1973  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_LEVEL: Transmit power level in signed mBm units.
1974  *      This is used in association with @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING
1975  *      for non-automatic settings.
1976  *
1977  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN, which mostly
1978  *	means support for per-station GTKs.
1979  *
1980  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX: Bitmap of allowed antennas for transmitting.
1981  *	This can be used to mask out antennas which are not attached or should
1982  *	not be used for transmitting. If an antenna is not selected in this
1983  *	bitmap the hardware is not allowed to transmit on this antenna.
1984  *
1985  *	Each bit represents one antenna, starting with antenna 1 at the first
1986  *	bit. Depending on which antennas are selected in the bitmap, 802.11n
1987  *	drivers can derive which chainmasks to use (if all antennas belonging to
1988  *	a particular chain are disabled this chain should be disabled) and if
1989  *	a chain has diversity antennas whether diversity should be used or not.
1990  *	HT capabilities (STBC, TX Beamforming, Antenna selection) can be
1991  *	derived from the available chains after applying the antenna mask.
1992  *	Non-802.11n drivers can derive whether to use diversity or not.
1993  *	Drivers may reject configurations or RX/TX mask combinations they cannot
1994  *	support by returning -EINVAL.
1995  *
1996  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_RX: Bitmap of allowed antennas for receiving.
1997  *	This can be used to mask out antennas which are not attached or should
1998  *	not be used for receiving. If an antenna is not selected in this bitmap
1999  *	the hardware should not be configured to receive on this antenna.
2000  *	For a more detailed description see @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX.
2001  *
2002  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_TX: Bitmap of antennas which are available
2003  *	for configuration as TX antennas via the above parameters.
2004  *
2005  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_RX: Bitmap of antennas which are available
2006  *	for configuration as RX antennas via the above parameters.
2007  *
2008  * @NL80211_ATTR_MCAST_RATE: Multicast tx rate (in 100 kbps) for IBSS
2009  *
2010  * @NL80211_ATTR_OFFCHANNEL_TX_OK: For management frame TX, the frame may be
2011  *	transmitted on another channel when the channel given doesn't match
2012  *	the current channel. If the current channel doesn't match and this
2013  *	flag isn't set, the frame will be rejected. This is also used as an
2014  *	nl80211 capability flag.
2015  *
2016  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_HT_OPMODE: HT operation mode (u16)
2017  *
2018  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: A nested attribute containing flags
2019  *	attributes, specifying what a key should be set as default as.
2020  *	See &enum nl80211_key_default_types.
2021  *
2022  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_SETUP: Optional mesh setup parameters.  These cannot be
2023  *	changed once the mesh is active.
2024  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG: Mesh configuration parameters, a nested attribute
2025  *	containing attributes from &enum nl80211_meshconf_params.
2026  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_MESH_AUTH: Currently, this means the underlying driver
2027  *	allows auth frames in a mesh to be passed to userspace for processing via
2028  *	the @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH flag.
2029  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_STATE: The state of a mesh peer link as defined in
2030  *	&enum nl80211_plink_state. Used when userspace is driving the peer link
2031  *	management state machine.  @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE or
2032  *	@NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM must be enabled.
2033  *
2034  * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED: indicates, as part of the wiphy
2035  *	capabilities, the supported WoWLAN triggers
2036  * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS: used by %NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN to
2037  *	indicate which WoW triggers should be enabled. This is also
2038  *	used by %NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN to get the currently enabled WoWLAN
2039  *	triggers.
2040  *
2041  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL: Interval between scheduled scan
2042  *	cycles, in msecs.
2043  *
2044  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH: Nested attribute with one or more
2045  *	sets of attributes to match during scheduled scans.  Only BSSs
2046  *	that match any of the sets will be reported.  These are
2047  *	pass-thru filter rules.
2048  *	For a match to succeed, the BSS must match all attributes of a
2049  *	set.  Since not every hardware supports matching all types of
2050  *	attributes, there is no guarantee that the reported BSSs are
2051  *	fully complying with the match sets and userspace needs to be
2052  *	able to ignore them by itself.
2053  *	Thus, the implementation is somewhat hardware-dependent, but
2054  *	this is only an optimization and the userspace application
2055  *	needs to handle all the non-filtered results anyway.
2056  *	If the match attributes don't make sense when combined with
2057  *	the values passed in @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS (eg. if an SSID
2058  *	is included in the probe request, but the match attributes
2059  *	will never let it go through), -EINVAL may be returned.
2060  *	If omitted, no filtering is done.
2061  *
2062  * @NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS: Nested attribute listing the supported
2063  *	interface combinations. In each nested item, it contains attributes
2064  *	defined in &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs.
2065  *	If the wiphy uses multiple radios (@NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RADIOS is set),
2066  *	this attribute contains the interface combinations of the first radio.
2067  *	See @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS for the global wiphy
2068  *	combinations for the sum of all radios.
2069  * @NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES: Nested attribute (just like
2070  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES) containing the interface types that
2071  *	are managed in software: interfaces of these types aren't subject to
2072  *	any restrictions in their number or combinations.
2073  *
2074  * @NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA: nested attribute containing the information
2075  *	necessary for GTK rekeying in the device, see &enum nl80211_rekey_data.
2076  *
2077  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SUPP_RATES: rates per to be advertised as supported in scan,
2078  *	nested array attribute containing an entry for each band, with the entry
2079  *	being a list of supported rates as defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but
2080  *	without the length restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
2081  *
2082  * @NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID: indicates whether SSID is to be hidden from Beacon
2083  *	and Probe Response (when response to wildcard Probe Request); see
2084  *	&enum nl80211_hidden_ssid, represented as a u32
2085  *
2086  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP: Information element(s) for Probe Response frame.
2087  *	This is used with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON and %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON to
2088  *	provide extra IEs (e.g., WPS/P2P IE) into Probe Response frames when the
2089  *	driver (or firmware) replies to Probe Request frames.
2090  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP: Information element(s) for (Re)Association
2091  *	Response frames. This is used with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON and
2092  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON to provide extra IEs (e.g., WPS/P2P IE) into
2093  *	(Re)Association Response frames when the driver (or firmware) replies to
2094  *	(Re)Association Request frames.
2095  *
2096  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_WME: Nested attribute containing the wme configuration
2097  *	of the station, see &enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr.
2098  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_AP_UAPSD: the device supports uapsd when working
2099  *	as AP.
2100  *
2101  * @NL80211_ATTR_ROAM_SUPPORT: Indicates whether the firmware is capable of
2102  *	roaming to another AP in the same ESS if the signal lever is low.
2103  *
2104  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: Nested attribute containing the PMKSA caching
2105  *	candidate information, see &enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr.
2106  *
2107  * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE: Indicates whether to use CCK rate or not
2108  *	for management frames transmission. In order to avoid p2p probe/action
2109  *	frames are being transmitted at CCK rate in 2GHz band, the user space
2110  *	applications use this attribute.
2111  *	This attribute is used with %NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN and
2112  *	%NL80211_CMD_FRAME commands.
2113  *
2114  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION: Low level TDLS action code (e.g. link setup
2115  *	request, link setup confirm, link teardown, etc.). Values are
2116  *	described in the TDLS (802.11z) specification.
2117  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_DIALOG_TOKEN: Non-zero token for uniquely identifying a
2118  *	TDLS conversation between two devices.
2119  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION: High level TDLS operation; see
2120  *	&enum nl80211_tdls_operation, represented as a u8.
2121  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_SUPPORT: A flag indicating the device can operate
2122  *	as a TDLS peer sta.
2123  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The TDLS discovery/setup and teardown
2124  *	procedures should be performed by sending TDLS packets via
2125  *	%NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT. Otherwise %NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be
2126  *	used for asking the driver to perform a TDLS operation.
2127  *
2128  * @NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME: This u32 attribute may be listed for devices
2129  *	that have AP support to indicate that they have the AP SME integrated
2130  *	with support for the features listed in this attribute, see
2131  *	&enum nl80211_ap_sme_features.
2132  *
2133  * @NL80211_ATTR_DONT_WAIT_FOR_ACK: Used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME, this tells
2134  *	the driver to not wait for an acknowledgement. Note that due to this,
2135  *	it will also not give a status callback nor return a cookie. This is
2136  *	mostly useful for probe responses to save airtime.
2137  *
2138  * @NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS: This u32 attribute contains flags from
2139  *	&enum nl80211_feature_flags and is advertised in wiphy information.
2140  * @NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: Indicates that the HW responds to probe
2141  *	requests while operating in AP-mode.
2142  *	This attribute holds a bitmap of the supported protocols for
2143  *	offloading (see &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr).
2144  *
2145  * @NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response template data. Contains the entire
2146  *	probe-response frame. The DA field in the 802.11 header is zero-ed out,
2147  *	to be filled by the FW.
2148  * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HT: Force HT capable interfaces to disable
2149  *      this feature during association. This is a flag attribute.
2150  *	Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers.
2151  * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_VHT: Force VHT capable interfaces to disable
2152  *      this feature during association. This is a flag attribute.
2153  *	Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers.
2154  * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HE: Force HE capable interfaces to disable
2155  *      this feature during association. This is a flag attribute.
2156  *	Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers.
2157  * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_EHT: Force EHT capable interfaces to disable
2158  *      this feature during association. This is a flag attribute.
2159  *	Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers.
2160  * @NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY_MASK: Specify which bits of the
2161  *      ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY to which attention should be paid.
2162  *      Currently, only mac80211 NICs support this feature.
2163  *      The values that may be configured are:
2164  *       MCS rates, MAX-AMSDU, HT-20-40 and HT_CAP_SGI_40
2165  *       AMPDU density and AMPDU factor.
2166  *      All values are treated as suggestions and may be ignored
2167  *      by the driver as required.  The actual values may be seen in
2168  *      the station debugfs ht_caps file.
2169  * @NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY_MASK: Specify which bits of the
2170  *      ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY to which attention should be paid.
2171  *      Currently, only mac80211 NICs support this feature.
2172  *      All values are treated as suggestions and may be ignored
2173  *      by the driver as required.  The actual values may be seen in
2174  *      the station debugfs vht_caps file.
2175  *
2176  * @NL80211_ATTR_DFS_REGION: region for regulatory rules which this country
2177  *    abides to when initiating radiation on DFS channels. A country maps
2178  *    to one DFS region.
2179  *
2180  * @NL80211_ATTR_NOACK_MAP: This u16 bitmap contains the No Ack Policy of
2181  *      up to 16 TIDs.
2182  *
2183  * @NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT: timeout value in seconds, this can be
2184  *	used by the drivers which has MLME in firmware and does not have support
2185  *	to report per station tx/rx activity to free up the station entry from
2186  *	the list. This needs to be used when the driver advertises the
2187  *	capability to timeout the stations.
2188  *
2189  * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_SIGNAL_DBM: signal strength in dBm (as a 32-bit int);
2190  *	this attribute is (depending on the driver capabilities) added to
2191  *	received frames indicated with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME.
2192  *
2193  * @NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD: Background scan period in seconds
2194  *      or 0 to disable background scan.
2195  *
2196  * @NL80211_ATTR_USER_REG_HINT_TYPE: type of regulatory hint passed from
2197  *	userspace. If unset it is assumed the hint comes directly from
2198  *	a user. If set code could specify exactly what type of source
2199  *	was used to provide the hint. For the different types of
2200  *	allowed user regulatory hints see nl80211_user_reg_hint_type.
2201  *
2202  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON: The reason for which AP has rejected
2203  *	the connection request from a station. nl80211_connect_failed_reason
2204  *	enum has different reasons of connection failure.
2205  *
2206  * @NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA: Fields and elements in Authentication frames.
2207  *	This contains the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data),
2208  *	excluding the Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the
2209  *	Authentication transaction sequence number field. It is used with
2210  *	authentication algorithms that need special fields to be added into
2211  *	the frames (SAE and FILS). Currently, only the SAE cases use the
2212  *	initial two fields (Authentication transaction sequence number and
2213  *	Status code). However, those fields are included in the attribute data
2214  *	for all authentication algorithms to keep the attribute definition
2215  *	consistent.
2216  *
2217  * @NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY: VHT Capability information element (from
2218  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
2219  *
2220  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FLAGS: scan request control flags (u32)
2221  *
2222  * @NL80211_ATTR_P2P_CTWINDOW: P2P GO Client Traffic Window (u8), used with
2223  *	the START_AP and SET_BSS commands
2224  * @NL80211_ATTR_P2P_OPPPS: P2P GO opportunistic PS (u8), used with the
2225  *	START_AP and SET_BSS commands. This can have the values 0 or 1;
2226  *	if not given in START_AP 0 is assumed, if not given in SET_BSS
2227  *	no change is made.
2228  *
2229  * @NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_MESH_POWER_MODE: local mesh STA link-specific power mode
2230  *	defined in &enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode.
2231  *
2232  * @NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY: ACL policy, see &enum nl80211_acl_policy,
2233  *	carried in a u32 attribute
2234  *
2235  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS: Array of nested MAC addresses, used for
2236  *	MAC ACL.
2237  *
2238  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ACL_MAX: u32 attribute to advertise the maximum
2239  *	number of MAC addresses that a device can support for MAC
2240  *	ACL.
2241  *
2242  * @NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT: Type of radar event for notification to userspace,
2243  *	contains a value of enum nl80211_radar_event (u32).
2244  *
2245  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA: 802.11 extended capabilities that the kernel driver
2246  *	has and handles. The format is the same as the IE contents. See
2247  *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for more information.
2248  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK: Extended capabilities that the kernel driver
2249  *	has set in the %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA value, for multibit fields.
2250  *
2251  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_CAPABILITY: Station capabilities (u16) are advertised to
2252  *	the driver, e.g., to enable TDLS power save (PU-APSD).
2253  *
2254  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_EXT_CAPABILITY: Station extended capabilities are
2255  *	advertised to the driver, e.g., to enable TDLS off channel operations
2256  *	and PU-APSD.
2257  *
2258  * @NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: global nl80211 feature flags, see
2259  *	&enum nl80211_protocol_features, the attribute is a u32.
2260  *
2261  * @NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP: flag attribute, userspace supports
2262  *	receiving the data for a single wiphy split across multiple
2263  *	messages, given with wiphy dump message
2264  *
2265  * @NL80211_ATTR_MDID: Mobility Domain Identifier
2266  *
2267  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_RIC: Resource Information Container Information
2268  *	Element
2269  *
2270  * @NL80211_ATTR_CRIT_PROT_ID: critical protocol identifier requiring increased
2271  *	reliability, see &enum nl80211_crit_proto_id (u16).
2272  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CRIT_PROT_DURATION: duration in milliseconds in which
2273  *      the connection should have increased reliability (u16).
2274  *
2275  * @NL80211_ATTR_PEER_AID: Association ID for the peer TDLS station (u16).
2276  *	This is similar to @NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID but with a difference of being
2277  *	allowed to be used with the first @NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION command to
2278  *	update a TDLS peer STA entry.
2279  *
2280  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE: Coalesce rule information.
2281  *
2282  * @NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT: u32 attribute specifying the number of TBTT's
2283  *	until the channel switch event.
2284  * @NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX: flag attribute specifying that transmission
2285  *	must be blocked on the current channel (before the channel switch
2286  *	operation). Also included in the channel switch started event if quiet
2287  *	was requested by the AP.
2288  * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_IES: Nested set of attributes containing the IE information
2289  *	for the time while performing a channel switch.
2290  * @NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON: An array of offsets (u16) to the channel
2291  *	switch or color change counters in the beacons tail (%NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL).
2292  * @NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP: An array of offsets (u16) to the channel
2293  *	switch or color change counters in the probe response (%NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP).
2294  *
2295  * @NL80211_ATTR_RXMGMT_FLAGS: flags for nl80211_send_mgmt(), u32.
2296  *	As specified in the &enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags.
2297  *
2298  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_CHANNELS: array of supported channels.
2299  *
2300  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_OPER_CLASSES: array of supported
2301  *      operating classes.
2302  *
2303  * @NL80211_ATTR_HANDLE_DFS: A flag indicating whether user space
2304  *	controls DFS operation in IBSS mode. If the flag is included in
2305  *	%NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS request, the driver will allow use of DFS
2306  *	channels and reports radar events to userspace. Userspace is required
2307  *	to react to radar events, e.g. initiate a channel switch or leave the
2308  *	IBSS network.
2309  *
2310  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_5_MHZ: A flag indicating that the device supports
2311  *	5 MHz channel bandwidth.
2312  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_10_MHZ: A flag indicating that the device supports
2313  *	10 MHz channel bandwidth.
2314  *
2315  * @NL80211_ATTR_OPMODE_NOTIF: Operating mode field from Operating Mode
2316  *	Notification Element based on association request when used with
2317  *	%NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION or %NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION (only when
2318  *	%NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE is supported, or with TDLS);
2319  *	u8 attribute.
2320  *
2321  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID: The vendor ID, either a 24-bit OUI or, if
2322  *	%NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX is set, a special Linux ID (not used yet)
2323  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD: vendor sub-command
2324  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA: data for the vendor command, if any; this
2325  *	attribute is also used for vendor command feature advertisement
2326  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_EVENTS: used for event list advertising in the wiphy
2327  *	info, containing a nested array of possible events
2328  *
2329  * @NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP: IP DSCP mapping for Interworking QoS mapping. This
2330  *	data is in the format defined for the payload of the QoS Map Set element
2331  *	in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97.
2332  *
2333  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT: MAC address recommendation as initial BSS
2334  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT: frequency of the recommended initial BSS
2335  *
2336  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_AP_ASSOC_STA: Device attribute that indicates how many
2337  *	associated stations are supported in AP mode (including P2P GO); u32.
2338  *	Since drivers may not have a fixed limit on the maximum number (e.g.,
2339  *	other concurrent operations may affect this), drivers are allowed to
2340  *	advertise values that cannot always be met. In such cases, an attempt
2341  *	to add a new station entry with @NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION may fail.
2342  *
2343  * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX: An array of csa counter offsets (u16) which
2344  *	should be updated when the frame is transmitted.
2345  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS: U8 attribute used to advertise the maximum
2346  *	supported number of csa counters.
2347  *
2348  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_PEER_CAPABILITY: flags for TDLS peer capabilities, u32.
2349  *	As specified in the &enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability.
2350  *
2351  * @NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER: Flag attribute, if set during interface
2352  *	creation then the new interface will be owned by the netlink socket
2353  *	that created it and will be destroyed when the socket is closed.
2354  *	If set during scheduled scan start then the new scan req will be
2355  *	owned by the netlink socket that created it and the scheduled scan will
2356  *	be stopped when the socket is closed.
2357  *	If set during configuration of regulatory indoor operation then the
2358  *	regulatory indoor configuration would be owned by the netlink socket
2359  *	that configured the indoor setting, and the indoor operation would be
2360  *	cleared when the socket is closed.
2361  *	If set during NAN interface creation, the interface will be destroyed
2362  *	if the socket is closed just like any other interface. Moreover, NAN
2363  *	notifications will be sent in unicast to that socket. Without this
2364  *	attribute, the notifications will be sent to the %NL80211_MCGRP_NAN
2365  *	multicast group.
2366  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE or %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT the
2367  *	station will deauthenticate when the socket is closed.
2368  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS the IBSS will be automatically
2369  *	torn down when the socket is closed.
2370  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH the mesh setup will be
2371  *	automatically torn down when the socket is closed.
2372  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_START_AP the AP will be automatically
2373  *	disabled when the socket is closed.
2374  *
2375  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_INITIATOR: flag attribute indicating the current end is
2376  *	the TDLS link initiator.
2377  *
2378  * @NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM: flag for indicating whether the current connection
2379  *	shall support Radio Resource Measurements (11k). This attribute can be
2380  *	used with %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests.
2381  *	User space applications are expected to use this flag only if the
2382  *	underlying device supports these minimal RRM features:
2383  *		%NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES,
2384  *		%NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET,
2385  *	Or, if global RRM is supported, see:
2386  *		%NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM
2387  *	If this flag is used, driver must add the Power Capabilities IE to the
2388  *	association request. In addition, it must also set the RRM capability
2389  *	flag in the association request's Capability Info field.
2390  *
2391  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK: flag attribute used to enable ACK timeout
2392  *	estimation algorithm (dynack). In order to activate dynack
2393  *	%NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION feature flag must be set by lower
2394  *	drivers to indicate dynack capability. Dynack is automatically disabled
2395  *	setting valid value for coverage class.
2396  *
2397  * @NL80211_ATTR_TSID: a TSID value (u8 attribute)
2398  * @NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO: user priority value (u8 attribute)
2399  * @NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME: admitted time in units of 32 microseconds
2400  *	(per second) (u16 attribute)
2401  *
2402  * @NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE: SMPS mode to use (ap mode). see
2403  *	&enum nl80211_smps_mode.
2404  *
2405  * @NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS: operating class
2406  *
2407  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK: MAC address mask
2408  *
2409  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG: flag attribute indicating this device
2410  *	is self-managing its regulatory information and any regulatory domain
2411  *	obtained from it is coming from the device's wiphy and not the global
2412  *	cfg80211 regdomain.
2413  *
2414  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_FEATURES: extended feature flags contained in a byte
2415  *	array. The feature flags are identified by their bit index (see &enum
2416  *	nl80211_ext_feature_index). The bit index is ordered starting at the
2417  *	least-significant bit of the first byte in the array, ie. bit index 0
2418  *	is located at bit 0 of byte 0. bit index 25 would be located at bit 1
2419  *	of byte 3 (u8 array).
2420  *
2421  * @NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_RADIO_STATS: Request overall radio statistics to be
2422  *	returned along with other survey data. If set, @NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY
2423  *	may return a survey entry without a channel indicating global radio
2424  *	statistics (only some values are valid and make sense.)
2425  *	For devices that don't return such an entry even then, the information
2426  *	should be contained in the result as the sum of the respective counters
2427  *	over all channels.
2428  *
2429  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY: delay before the first cycle of a
2430  *	scheduled scan is started.  Or the delay before a WoWLAN
2431  *	net-detect scan is started, counting from the moment the
2432  *	system is suspended.  This value is a u32, in seconds.
2433  *
2434  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_INDOOR: flag attribute, if set indicates that the device
2435  *      is operating in an indoor environment.
2436  *
2437  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS: maximum number of scan plans for
2438  *	scheduled scan supported by the device (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2439  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL: maximum interval (in seconds) for
2440  *	a scan plan (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2441  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS: maximum number of iterations in
2442  *	a scan plan (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2443  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS: a list of scan plans for scheduled scan.
2444  *	Each scan plan defines the number of scan iterations and the interval
2445  *	between scans. The last scan plan will always run infinitely,
2446  *	thus it must not specify the number of iterations, only the interval
2447  *	between scans. The scan plans are executed sequentially.
2448  *	Each scan plan is a nested attribute of &enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan.
2449  * @NL80211_ATTR_PBSS: flag attribute. If set it means operate
2450  *	in a PBSS. Specified in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to request
2451  *	connecting to a PCP, and in %NL80211_CMD_START_AP to start
2452  *	a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG networks only.
2453  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT: nested attribute for driver supporting the
2454  *	BSS selection feature. When used with %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY it contains
2455  *	attributes according &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr to indicate what
2456  *	BSS selection behaviours are supported. When used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
2457  *	it contains the behaviour-specific attribute containing the parameters for
2458  *	BSS selection to be done by driver and/or firmware.
2459  *
2460  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORT_P2P_PS: whether P2P PS mechanism supported
2461  *	or not. u8, one of the values of &enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status
2462  *
2463  * @NL80211_ATTR_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
2464  *
2465  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_EXT_CAPA: Nested attribute of the following attributes:
2466  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA,
2467  *	%NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK, to specify the extended capabilities and
2468  *	other interface-type specific capabilities per interface type. For MLO,
2469  *	%NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY and %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS are
2470  *	present.
2471  *
2472  * @NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA: array of 24 bytes that defines a MU-MIMO
2473  *	groupID for monitor mode.
2474  *	The first 8 bytes are a mask that defines the membership in each
2475  *	group (there are 64 groups, group 0 and 63 are reserved),
2476  *	each bit represents a group and set to 1 for being a member in
2477  *	that group and 0 for not being a member.
2478  *	The remaining 16 bytes define the position in each group: 2 bits for
2479  *	each group.
2480  *	(smaller group numbers represented on most significant bits and bigger
2481  *	group numbers on least significant bits.)
2482  *	This attribute is used only if all interfaces are in monitor mode.
2483  *	Set this attribute in order to monitor packets using the given MU-MIMO
2484  *	groupID data.
2485  *	to turn off that feature set all the bits of the groupID to zero.
2486  * @NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR: mac address for the sniffer to follow
2487  *	when using MU-MIMO air sniffer.
2488  *	to turn that feature off set an invalid mac address
2489  *	(e.g. FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF)
2490  *
2491  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF: The time at which the scan was actually
2492  *	started (u64). The time is the TSF of the BSS the interface that
2493  *	requested the scan is connected to (if available, otherwise this
2494  *	attribute must not be included).
2495  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF_BSSID: The BSS according to which
2496  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF is set.
2497  * @NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION: measurement duration in TUs (u16). If
2498  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY is not set, this is the
2499  *	maximum measurement duration allowed. This attribute is used with
2500  *	measurement requests. It can also be used with %NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN
2501  *	if the scan is used for beacon report radio measurement.
2502  * @NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY: flag attribute that indicates
2503  *	that the duration specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION is
2504  *	mandatory. If this flag is not set, the duration is the maximum duration
2505  *	and the actual measurement duration may be shorter.
2506  *
2507  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PEER_AID: Association ID for the mesh peer (u16). This is
2508  *	used to pull the stored data for mesh peer in power save state.
2509  *
2510  * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF: the master preference to be used by
2511  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN and optionally with
2512  *	%NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG. Its type is u8 and it can't be 0.
2513  *	Also, values 1 and 255 are reserved for certification purposes and
2514  *	should not be used during a normal device operation.
2515  * @NL80211_ATTR_BANDS: operating bands configuration.  This is a u32
2516  *	bitmask of BIT(NL80211_BAND_*) as described in %enum
2517  *	nl80211_band.  For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0
2518  *	would be set.  This attribute is used with
2519  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN and %NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG, and
2520  *	it is optional.  If no bands are set, it means don't-care and
2521  *	the device will decide what to use.
2522  * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC: a function that can be added to NAN. See
2523  *	&enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes for description of this nested
2524  *	attribute.
2525  * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH: used to report a match. This is a nested attribute.
2526  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes.
2527  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK: KEK for FILS (Re)Association Request/Response frame
2528  *	protection.
2529  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES: Nonces (part of AAD) for FILS (Re)Association
2530  *	Request/Response frame protection. This attribute contains the 16 octet
2531  *	STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce.
2532  *
2533  * @NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED: Indicates whether or not multicast
2534  *	packets should be send out as unicast to all stations (flag attribute).
2535  *
2536  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSSID: The BSSID of the AP. Note that %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is also
2537  *	used in various commands/events for specifying the BSSID.
2538  *
2539  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI: Relative RSSI threshold by which
2540  *	other BSSs has to be better or slightly worse than the current
2541  *	connected BSS so that they get reported to user space.
2542  *	This will give an opportunity to userspace to consider connecting to
2543  *	other matching BSSs which have better or slightly worse RSSI than
2544  *	the current connected BSS by using an offloaded operation to avoid
2545  *	unnecessary wakeups.
2546  *
2547  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for BSSs in
2548  *	the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
2549  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI based comparison to figure out
2550  *	better BSSs. The attribute value is a packed structure
2551  *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
2552  *
2553  * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT_REASON: The reason for which an operation timed out.
2554  *	u32 attribute with an &enum nl80211_timeout_reason value. This is used,
2555  *	e.g., with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT event.
2556  *
2557  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME: EAP Re-authentication Protocol (ERP)
2558  *	username part of NAI used to refer keys rRK and rIK. This is used with
2559  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2560  *
2561  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM: EAP Re-authentication Protocol (ERP) realm part
2562  *	of NAI specifying the domain name of the ER server. This is used with
2563  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2564  *
2565  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM: Unsigned 16-bit ERP next sequence number
2566  *	to use in ERP messages. This is used in generating the FILS wrapped data
2567  *	for FILS authentication and is used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2568  *
2569  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) for the
2570  *	NAI specified by %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME and
2571  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM. This is used for generating rIK and rMSK
2572  *	from successful FILS authentication and is used with
2573  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2574  *
2575  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID: A 2-octet identifier advertised by a FILS AP
2576  *	identifying the scope of PMKSAs. This is used with
2577  *	@NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA and @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA.
2578  *
2579  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK: attribute for passing PMK key material. Used with
2580  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA for the PMKSA identified by %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID.
2581  *	For %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP it is used to provide
2582  *	PSK for offloading 4-way handshake for WPA/WPA2-PSK networks. For 802.1X
2583  *	authentication it is used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK. For offloaded FT
2584  *	support this attribute specifies the PMK-R0 if NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME
2585  *	is included as well.
2586  *
2587  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI: flag attribute which user-space shall use to
2588  *	indicate that it supports multiple active scheduled scan requests.
2589  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MAX_REQS: indicates maximum number of scheduled
2590  *	scan request that may be active for the device (u32).
2591  *
2592  * @NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS: flag attribute which user-space can include
2593  *	in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to indicate that for 802.1X authentication it
2594  *	wants to use the supported offload of the 4-way handshake.
2595  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME: PMK-R0 Name for offloaded FT.
2596  * @NL80211_ATTR_PORT_AUTHORIZED: (reserved)
2597  *
2598  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION: Identify the requested external
2599  *     authentication operation (u32 attribute with an
2600  *     &enum nl80211_external_auth_action value). This is used with the
2601  *     %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH request event.
2602  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: Flag attribute indicating that the user
2603  *	space supports external authentication. This attribute shall be used
2604  *	with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP request. The driver
2605  *	may offload authentication processing to user space if this capability
2606  *	is indicated in the respective requests from the user space. (This flag
2607  *	attribute deprecated for %NL80211_CMD_START_AP, use
2608  *	%NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS)
2609  *
2610  * @NL80211_ATTR_NSS: Station's New/updated  RX_NSS value notified using this
2611  *	u8 attribute. This is used with %NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED.
2612  *
2613  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_STATS: TXQ statistics (nested attribute, see &enum
2614  *      nl80211_txq_stats)
2615  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_LIMIT: Total packet limit for the TXQ queues for this phy.
2616  *      The smaller of this and the memory limit is enforced.
2617  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: Total memory limit (in bytes) for the
2618  *      TXQ queues for this phy. The smaller of this and the packet limit is
2619  *      enforced.
2620  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum (bytes). Number of bytes
2621  *      a flow is assigned on each round of the DRR scheduler.
2622  * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_CAPABILITY: HE Capability information element (from
2623  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION). Can be set
2624  *	only if %NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME is set.
2625  *
2626  * @NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER: nested attribute which user-space can include
2627  *	in %NL80211_CMD_START_AP or %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON for fine timing
2628  *	measurement (FTM) responder functionality and containing parameters as
2629  *	possible, see &enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attr
2630  *
2631  * @NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS: Nested attribute with FTM responder
2632  *	statistics, see &enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats.
2633  *
2634  * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT: Timeout for the given operation in milliseconds (u32),
2635  *	if the attribute is not given no timeout is requested. Note that 0 is an
2636  *	invalid value.
2637  *
2638  * @NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS: peer measurements request (and result)
2639  *	data, uses nested attributes specified in
2640  *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs.
2641  *	This is also used for capability advertisement in the wiphy information,
2642  *	with the appropriate sub-attributes.
2643  *
2644  * @NL80211_ATTR_AIRTIME_WEIGHT: Station's weight when scheduled by the airtime
2645  *	scheduler.
2646  *
2647  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER_SETTING: Transmit power setting type (u8) for
2648  *	station associated with the AP. See &enum nl80211_tx_power_setting for
2649  *	possible values.
2650  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER: Transmit power level (s16) in dBm units. This
2651  *	allows to set Tx power for a station. If this attribute is not included,
2652  *	the default per-interface tx power setting will be overriding. Driver
2653  *	should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx power per-interface
2654  *	or per-station.
2655  *
2656  * @NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD: attribute for passing SAE password material. It
2657  *	is used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to provide password for offloading
2658  *	SAE authentication for WPA3-Personal networks.
2659  *
2660  * @NL80211_ATTR_TWT_RESPONDER: Enable target wait time responder support.
2661  *
2662  * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_OBSS_PD: nested attribute for OBSS Packet Detection
2663  *	functionality.
2664  *
2665  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_CHANNELS: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz
2666  *	channel(s) that are allowed to be used for EDMG transmissions.
2667  *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251. (u8 attribute)
2668  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_BW_CONFIG: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
2669  *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations. (u8 attribute)
2670  *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251, Table 13.
2671  *
2672  * @NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID: VLAN ID (1..4094) for the station and VLAN group key
2673  *	(u16).
2674  *
2675  * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_BSS_COLOR: nested attribute for BSS Color Settings.
2676  *
2677  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_AKM_SUITES: nested array attribute, with each entry
2678  *	using attributes from &enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes. This
2679  *	attribute is sent in a response to %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY indicating
2680  *	supported AKM suites capability per interface. AKMs advertised in
2681  *	%NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES are default capabilities if AKM suites not
2682  *	advertised for a specific interface type.
2683  *
2684  * @NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG: TID specific configuration in a
2685  *	nested attribute with &enum nl80211_tid_config_attr sub-attributes;
2686  *	on output (in wiphy attributes) it contains only the feature sub-
2687  *	attributes.
2688  *
2689  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH: disable preauth frame rx on control
2690  *	port in order to forward/receive them as ordinary data frames.
2691  *
2692  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds (u32,
2693  *	dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold; 0 is not a valid value).
2694  *	An optional parameter configured through %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA.
2695  *	Drivers that trigger roaming need to know the lifetime of the
2696  *	configured PMKSA for triggering the full vs. PMKSA caching based
2697  *	authentication. This timeout helps authentication methods like SAE,
2698  *	where PMK gets updated only by going through a full (new SAE)
2699  *	authentication instead of getting updated during an association for EAP
2700  *	authentication. No new full authentication within the PMK expiry shall
2701  *	result in a disassociation at the end of the lifetime.
2702  *
2703  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK_REAUTH_THRESHOLD: Reauthentication threshold time, in
2704  *	terms of percentage of %NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME
2705  *	(u8, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold, 1..100). This is an optional
2706  *	parameter configured through %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA. Requests the
2707  *	driver to trigger a full authentication roam (without PMKSA caching)
2708  *	after the reauthentication threshold time, but before the PMK lifetime
2709  *	has expired.
2710  *
2711  *	Authentication methods like SAE need to be able to generate a new PMKSA
2712  *	entry without having to force a disconnection after the PMK timeout. If
2713  *	no roaming occurs between the reauth threshold and PMK expiration,
2714  *	disassociation is still forced.
2715  * @NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST: multicast flag for the
2716  *	%NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME command, see the description there.
2717  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET: offset of the associated
2718  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ in positive KHz. Only valid when supplied with
2719  *	an %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET.
2720  * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1_OFFSET: Center frequency offset in KHz for the
2721  *	first channel segment specified in %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1.
2722  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ: nested attribute with KHz frequencies
2723  *
2724  * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPABILITY: HE 6 GHz Band Capability element (from
2725  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION).
2726  *
2727  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_DISCOVERY: Optional parameter to configure FILS
2728  *	discovery. It is a nested attribute, see
2729  *	&enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes. Userspace should pass an empty
2730  *	nested attribute to disable this feature and delete the templates.
2731  *
2732  * @NL80211_ATTR_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Optional parameter to configure
2733  *	unsolicited broadcast probe response. It is a nested attribute, see
2734  *	&enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes. Userspace should pass an empty
2735  *	nested attribute to disable this feature and delete the templates.
2736  *
2737  * @NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY: S1G Capability information element (from
2738  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
2739  * @NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY_MASK: S1G Capability Information element
2740  *	override mask. Used with NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY in
2741  *	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE or NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2742  *
2743  * @NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PWE: Indicates the mechanism(s) allowed for SAE PWE
2744  *	derivation in WPA3-Personal networks which are using SAE authentication.
2745  *	This is a u8 attribute that encapsulates one of the values from
2746  *	&enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism.
2747  *
2748  * @NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC: SAR power limitation specification when
2749  *	used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS. The message contains fields
2750  *	of %nl80211_sar_attrs which specifies the sar type and related
2751  *	sar specs. Sar specs contains array of %nl80211_sar_specs_attrs.
2752  *
2753  * @NL80211_ATTR_RECONNECT_REQUESTED: flag attribute, used with deauth and
2754  *	disassoc events to indicate that an immediate reconnect to the AP
2755  *	is desired.
2756  *
2757  * @NL80211_ATTR_OBSS_COLOR_BITMAP: bitmap of the u64 BSS colors for the
2758  *	%NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION event.
2759  *
2760  * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COUNT: u8 attribute specifying the number of TBTT's
2761  *	until the color switch event.
2762  * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COLOR: u8 attribute specifying the color that we are
2763  *	switching to
2764  * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_ELEMS: Nested set of attributes containing the IE
2765  *	information for the time while performing a color switch.
2766  *
2767  * @NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG: Nested attribute for multiple BSSID
2768  *	advertisements (MBSSID) parameters in AP mode.
2769  *	Kernel uses this attribute to indicate the driver's support for MBSSID
2770  *	and enhanced multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA AP) to the userspace.
2771  *	Userspace should use this attribute to configure per interface MBSSID
2772  *	parameters.
2773  *	See &enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes for details.
2774  *
2775  * @NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS: Nested parameter to pass multiple BSSID elements.
2776  *	Mandatory parameter for the transmitting interface to enable MBSSID.
2777  *	Optional for the non-transmitting interfaces.
2778  *
2779  * @NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_BACKGROUND: Configure dedicated offchannel chain
2780  *	available for radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used
2781  *	to transmit or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
2782  *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
2783  *	switching on a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
2784  *	radar channel.
2785  *
2786  * @NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS: u32 attribute contains ap settings flags,
2787  *	enumerated in &enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags. This attribute shall be
2788  *	used with %NL80211_CMD_START_AP request.
2789  *
2790  * @NL80211_ATTR_EHT_CAPABILITY: EHT Capability information element (from
2791  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION). Can be set
2792  *	only if %NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME is set.
2793  *
2794  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID: A (u8) link ID for use with MLO, to be used with
2795  *	various commands that need a link ID to operate.
2796  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS: A nested array of links, each containing some
2797  *	per-link information and a link ID.
2798  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR: An MLD address, used with various commands such as
2799  *	authenticate/associate.
2800  *
2801  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT: Flag attribute to indicate user space supports MLO
2802  *	connection. Used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. If this attribute is not
2803  *	included in NL80211_CMD_CONNECT drivers must not perform MLO connection.
2804  *
2805  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES: U16 attribute. Indicates maximum number of
2806  *	AKM suites allowed for %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT, %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and
2807  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_AP in %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY response. If this
2808  *	attribute is not present userspace shall consider maximum number of AKM
2809  *	suites allowed as %NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES which is the legacy maximum
2810  *	number prior to the introduction of this attribute.
2811  *
2812  * @NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY: EML Capability information (u16)
2813  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS: MLD Capabilities and Operations (u16)
2814  *
2815  * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP: Hardware timestamp for TX operation in
2816  *	nanoseconds (u64). This is the device clock timestamp so it will
2817  *	probably reset when the device is stopped or the firmware is reset.
2818  *	When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS, indicates the frame TX
2819  *	timestamp. When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME RX notification, indicates
2820  *	the ack TX timestamp.
2821  * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP: Hardware timestamp for RX operation in
2822  *	nanoseconds (u64). This is the device clock timestamp so it will
2823  *	probably reset when the device is stopped or the firmware is reset.
2824  *	When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS, indicates the ack RX
2825  *	timestamp. When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME RX notification, indicates
2826  *	the incoming frame RX timestamp.
2827  * @NL80211_ATTR_TD_BITMAP: Transition Disable bitmap, for subsequent
2828  *	(re)associations.
2829  *
2830  * @NL80211_ATTR_PUNCT_BITMAP: (u32) Preamble puncturing bitmap, lowest
2831  *	bit corresponds to the lowest 20 MHz channel. Each bit set to 1
2832  *	indicates that the sub-channel is punctured. Higher 16 bits are
2833  *	reserved.
2834  *
2835  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_HW_TIMESTAMP_PEERS: Maximum number of peers that HW
2836  *	timestamping can be enabled for concurrently (u16), a wiphy attribute.
2837  *	A value of 0xffff indicates setting for all peers (i.e. not specifying
2838  *	an address with %NL80211_CMD_SET_HW_TIMESTAMP) is supported.
2839  * @NL80211_ATTR_HW_TIMESTAMP_ENABLED: Indicates whether HW timestamping should
2840  *	be enabled or not (flag attribute).
2841  *
2842  * @NL80211_ATTR_EMA_RNR_ELEMS: Optional nested attribute for
2843  *	reduced neighbor report (RNR) elements. This attribute can be used
2844  *	only when NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_EMA is enabled.
2845  *	Userspace is responsible for splitting the RNR into multiple
2846  *	elements such that each element excludes the non-transmitting
2847  *	profiles already included in the MBSSID element
2848  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS) at the same index. Each EMA beacon
2849  *	will be generated by adding MBSSID and RNR elements at the same
2850  *	index. If the userspace includes more RNR elements than number of
2851  *	MBSSID elements then these will be added in every EMA beacon.
2852  *
2853  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_DISABLED: Flag attribute indicating that the link is
2854  *	disabled.
2855  *
2856  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_DUMP_INCLUDE_USE_DATA: Include BSS usage data, i.e.
2857  *	include BSSes that can only be used in restricted scenarios and/or
2858  *	cannot be used at all.
2859  *
2860  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_TTLM_DLINK: Binary attribute specifying the downlink TID to
2861  *      link mapping. The length is 8 * sizeof(u16). For each TID the link
2862  *      mapping is as defined in section 9.4.2.314 (TID-To-Link Mapping element)
2863  *      in Draft P802.11be_D4.0.
2864  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_TTLM_ULINK: Binary attribute specifying the uplink TID to
2865  *      link mapping. The length is 8 * sizeof(u16). For each TID the link
2866  *      mapping is as defined in section 9.4.2.314 (TID-To-Link Mapping element)
2867  *      in Draft P802.11be_D4.0.
2868  *
2869  * @NL80211_ATTR_ASSOC_SPP_AMSDU: flag attribute used with
2870  *	%NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE indicating the SPP A-MSDUs
2871  *	are used on this connection
2872  *
2873  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RADIOS: Nested attribute describing physical radios
2874  *	belonging to this wiphy. See &enum nl80211_wiphy_radio_attrs.
2875  *
2876  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS: Nested attribute listing the
2877  *	supported interface combinations for all radios combined. In each
2878  *	nested item, it contains attributes defined in
2879  *	&enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs.
2880  *
2881  * @NL80211_ATTR_VIF_RADIO_MASK: Bitmask of allowed radios (u32).
2882  *	A value of 0 means all radios.
2883  *
2884  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_SELECTORS: supported selectors, array of
2885  *	supported selectors as defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but without the
2886  *	length restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_SELECTORS).
2887  *	This can be used to provide a list of selectors that are implemented
2888  *	by the supplicant. If not given, support for SAE_H2E is assumed.
2889  *
2890  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_RECONF_REM_LINKS: (u16) A bitmask of the links requested
2891  *      to be removed from the MLO association.
2892  *
2893  * @NL80211_ATTR_EPCS: Flag attribute indicating that EPCS is enabled for a
2894  *	station interface.
2895  *
2896  * @NUM_NL80211_ATTR: total number of nl80211_attrs available
2897  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number currently defined
2898  * @__NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
2899  */
2900 enum nl80211_attrs {
2901 /* don't change the order or add anything between, this is ABI! */
2902 	NL80211_ATTR_UNSPEC,
2903 
2904 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY,
2905 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME,
2906 
2907 	NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX,
2908 	NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME,
2909 	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE,
2910 
2911 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC,
2912 
2913 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA,
2914 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX,
2915 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER,
2916 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ,
2917 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT,
2918 
2919 	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL,
2920 	NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD,
2921 	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD,
2922 	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL,
2923 
2924 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID,
2925 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS,
2926 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_LISTEN_INTERVAL,
2927 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_RATES,
2928 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN,
2929 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO,
2930 
2931 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_BANDS,
2932 
2933 	NL80211_ATTR_MNTR_FLAGS,
2934 
2935 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_ID,
2936 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_ACTION,
2937 	NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP,
2938 	NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO,
2939 
2940 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_CTS_PROT,
2941 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
2942 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME,
2943 
2944 	NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY,
2945 
2946 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES,
2947 
2948 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2,
2949 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULES,
2950 
2951 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG,
2952 
2953 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES,
2954 
2955 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS,
2956 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ,
2957 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE,
2958 
2959 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT,
2960 
2961 	NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE,
2962 	NL80211_ATTR_IE,
2963 
2964 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCAN_SSIDS,
2965 
2966 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES,
2967 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS,
2968 	NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION, /* replaces old SCAN_GENERATION */
2969 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS,
2970 
2971 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR,
2972 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE,
2973 
2974 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_COMMANDS,
2975 
2976 	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME,
2977 	NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
2978 	NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE,
2979 	NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE,
2980 
2981 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE,
2982 
2983 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_IE_LEN,
2984 	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES,
2985 
2986 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE,
2987 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER,
2988 
2989 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_FIXED,
2990 
2991 
2992 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT,
2993 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG,
2994 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD,
2995 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD,
2996 
2997 	NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT,
2998 
2999 	NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP,
3000 
3001 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2,
3002 
3003 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT,
3004 
3005 	NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA,
3006 
3007 	NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY,
3008 
3009 	NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP,
3010 	NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE,
3011 
3012 	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE,
3013 	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP,
3014 	NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS,
3015 	NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES,
3016 
3017 	NL80211_ATTR_REQ_IE,
3018 	NL80211_ATTR_RESP_IE,
3019 
3020 	NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID,
3021 
3022 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY,
3023 	NL80211_ATTR_KEYS,
3024 
3025 	NL80211_ATTR_PID,
3026 
3027 	NL80211_ATTR_4ADDR,
3028 
3029 	NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO,
3030 
3031 	NL80211_ATTR_PMKID,
3032 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_PMKIDS,
3033 
3034 	NL80211_ATTR_DURATION,
3035 
3036 	NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE,
3037 
3038 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_COVERAGE_CLASS,
3039 
3040 	NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES,
3041 
3042 	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_MATCH,
3043 
3044 	NL80211_ATTR_ACK,
3045 
3046 	NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE,
3047 
3048 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM,
3049 
3050 	NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_STATE_CHANGE,
3051 
3052 	NL80211_ATTR_AP_ISOLATE,
3053 
3054 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING,
3055 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_LEVEL,
3056 
3057 	NL80211_ATTR_TX_FRAME_TYPES,
3058 	NL80211_ATTR_RX_FRAME_TYPES,
3059 	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE,
3060 
3061 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
3062 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT,
3063 
3064 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_IBSS_RSN,
3065 
3066 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX,
3067 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_RX,
3068 
3069 	NL80211_ATTR_MCAST_RATE,
3070 
3071 	NL80211_ATTR_OFFCHANNEL_TX_OK,
3072 
3073 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_HT_OPMODE,
3074 
3075 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES,
3076 
3077 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_DURATION,
3078 
3079 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_SETUP,
3080 
3081 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_TX,
3082 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_RX,
3083 
3084 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_MESH_AUTH,
3085 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_STATE,
3086 
3087 	NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS,
3088 	NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED,
3089 
3090 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL,
3091 
3092 	NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS,
3093 	NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES,
3094 
3095 	NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA,
3096 
3097 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_SSIDS,
3098 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCHED_SCAN_IE_LEN,
3099 
3100 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SUPP_RATES,
3101 
3102 	NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID,
3103 
3104 	NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP,
3105 	NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP,
3106 
3107 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_WME,
3108 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_AP_UAPSD,
3109 
3110 	NL80211_ATTR_ROAM_SUPPORT,
3111 
3112 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH,
3113 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_MATCH_SETS,
3114 
3115 	NL80211_ATTR_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
3116 
3117 	NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE,
3118 
3119 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION,
3120 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_DIALOG_TOKEN,
3121 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION,
3122 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_SUPPORT,
3123 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP,
3124 
3125 	NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME,
3126 
3127 	NL80211_ATTR_DONT_WAIT_FOR_ACK,
3128 
3129 	NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS,
3130 
3131 	NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD,
3132 
3133 	NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP,
3134 
3135 	NL80211_ATTR_DFS_REGION,
3136 
3137 	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HT,
3138 	NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY_MASK,
3139 
3140 	NL80211_ATTR_NOACK_MAP,
3141 
3142 	NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT,
3143 
3144 	NL80211_ATTR_RX_SIGNAL_DBM,
3145 
3146 	NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD,
3147 
3148 	NL80211_ATTR_WDEV,
3149 
3150 	NL80211_ATTR_USER_REG_HINT_TYPE,
3151 
3152 	NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON,
3153 
3154 	NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA,
3155 
3156 	NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY,
3157 
3158 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FLAGS,
3159 
3160 	NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH,
3161 	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1,
3162 	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2,
3163 
3164 	NL80211_ATTR_P2P_CTWINDOW,
3165 	NL80211_ATTR_P2P_OPPPS,
3166 
3167 	NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_MESH_POWER_MODE,
3168 
3169 	NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY,
3170 
3171 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS,
3172 
3173 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ACL_MAX,
3174 
3175 	NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT,
3176 
3177 	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA,
3178 	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK,
3179 
3180 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_CAPABILITY,
3181 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_EXT_CAPABILITY,
3182 
3183 	NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES,
3184 	NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP,
3185 
3186 	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_VHT,
3187 	NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY_MASK,
3188 
3189 	NL80211_ATTR_MDID,
3190 	NL80211_ATTR_IE_RIC,
3191 
3192 	NL80211_ATTR_CRIT_PROT_ID,
3193 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CRIT_PROT_DURATION,
3194 
3195 	NL80211_ATTR_PEER_AID,
3196 
3197 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE,
3198 
3199 	NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT,
3200 	NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX,
3201 	NL80211_ATTR_CSA_IES,
3202 	NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON,
3203 	NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP,
3204 
3205 	NL80211_ATTR_RXMGMT_FLAGS,
3206 
3207 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_CHANNELS,
3208 
3209 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_OPER_CLASSES,
3210 
3211 	NL80211_ATTR_HANDLE_DFS,
3212 
3213 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_5_MHZ,
3214 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_10_MHZ,
3215 
3216 	NL80211_ATTR_OPMODE_NOTIF,
3217 
3218 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID,
3219 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD,
3220 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
3221 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_EVENTS,
3222 
3223 	NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP,
3224 
3225 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT,
3226 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT,
3227 
3228 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_AP_ASSOC_STA,
3229 
3230 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_PEER_CAPABILITY,
3231 
3232 	NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER,
3233 
3234 	NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX,
3235 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS,
3236 
3237 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_INITIATOR,
3238 
3239 	NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM,
3240 
3241 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK,
3242 
3243 	NL80211_ATTR_TSID,
3244 	NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO,
3245 	NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME,
3246 
3247 	NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE,
3248 
3249 	NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS,
3250 
3251 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK,
3252 
3253 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG,
3254 
3255 	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_FEATURES,
3256 
3257 	NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_RADIO_STATS,
3258 
3259 	NL80211_ATTR_NETNS_FD,
3260 
3261 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY,
3262 
3263 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_INDOOR,
3264 
3265 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS,
3266 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL,
3267 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS,
3268 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS,
3269 
3270 	NL80211_ATTR_PBSS,
3271 
3272 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT,
3273 
3274 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORT_P2P_PS,
3275 
3276 	NL80211_ATTR_PAD,
3277 
3278 	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_EXT_CAPA,
3279 
3280 	NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA,
3281 	NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR,
3282 
3283 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF,
3284 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF_BSSID,
3285 	NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION,
3286 	NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY,
3287 
3288 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PEER_AID,
3289 
3290 	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF,
3291 	NL80211_ATTR_BANDS,
3292 	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC,
3293 	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH,
3294 
3295 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK,
3296 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES,
3297 
3298 	NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED,
3299 
3300 	NL80211_ATTR_BSSID,
3301 
3302 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI,
3303 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RSSI_ADJUST,
3304 
3305 	NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT_REASON,
3306 
3307 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME,
3308 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM,
3309 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM,
3310 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK,
3311 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID,
3312 
3313 	NL80211_ATTR_PMK,
3314 
3315 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI,
3316 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MAX_REQS,
3317 
3318 	NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS,
3319 	NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME,
3320 	NL80211_ATTR_PORT_AUTHORIZED,
3321 
3322 	NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION,
3323 	NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT,
3324 
3325 	NL80211_ATTR_NSS,
3326 	NL80211_ATTR_ACK_SIGNAL,
3327 
3328 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211,
3329 
3330 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_STATS,
3331 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_LIMIT,
3332 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT,
3333 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_QUANTUM,
3334 
3335 	NL80211_ATTR_HE_CAPABILITY,
3336 
3337 	NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER,
3338 
3339 	NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS,
3340 
3341 	NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT,
3342 
3343 	NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS,
3344 
3345 	NL80211_ATTR_AIRTIME_WEIGHT,
3346 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER_SETTING,
3347 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER,
3348 
3349 	NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD,
3350 
3351 	NL80211_ATTR_TWT_RESPONDER,
3352 
3353 	NL80211_ATTR_HE_OBSS_PD,
3354 
3355 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_CHANNELS,
3356 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_BW_CONFIG,
3357 
3358 	NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID,
3359 
3360 	NL80211_ATTR_HE_BSS_COLOR,
3361 
3362 	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_AKM_SUITES,
3363 
3364 	NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG,
3365 
3366 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH,
3367 
3368 	NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME,
3369 	NL80211_ATTR_PMK_REAUTH_THRESHOLD,
3370 
3371 	NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST,
3372 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET,
3373 	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1_OFFSET,
3374 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ,
3375 
3376 	NL80211_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPABILITY,
3377 
3378 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_DISCOVERY,
3379 
3380 	NL80211_ATTR_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP,
3381 
3382 	NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY,
3383 	NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY_MASK,
3384 
3385 	NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PWE,
3386 
3387 	NL80211_ATTR_RECONNECT_REQUESTED,
3388 
3389 	NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC,
3390 
3391 	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HE,
3392 
3393 	NL80211_ATTR_OBSS_COLOR_BITMAP,
3394 
3395 	NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COUNT,
3396 	NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COLOR,
3397 	NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_ELEMS,
3398 
3399 	NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG,
3400 	NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS,
3401 
3402 	NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_BACKGROUND,
3403 
3404 	NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS,
3405 
3406 	NL80211_ATTR_EHT_CAPABILITY,
3407 
3408 	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_EHT,
3409 
3410 	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS,
3411 	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID,
3412 	NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR,
3413 
3414 	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT,
3415 
3416 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES,
3417 
3418 	NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY,
3419 	NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS,
3420 
3421 	NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP,
3422 	NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP,
3423 	NL80211_ATTR_TD_BITMAP,
3424 
3425 	NL80211_ATTR_PUNCT_BITMAP,
3426 
3427 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_HW_TIMESTAMP_PEERS,
3428 	NL80211_ATTR_HW_TIMESTAMP_ENABLED,
3429 
3430 	NL80211_ATTR_EMA_RNR_ELEMS,
3431 
3432 	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_DISABLED,
3433 
3434 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_DUMP_INCLUDE_USE_DATA,
3435 
3436 	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_TTLM_DLINK,
3437 	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_TTLM_ULINK,
3438 
3439 	NL80211_ATTR_ASSOC_SPP_AMSDU,
3440 
3441 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RADIOS,
3442 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS,
3443 
3444 	NL80211_ATTR_VIF_RADIO_MASK,
3445 
3446 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_SELECTORS,
3447 
3448 	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_RECONF_REM_LINKS,
3449 	NL80211_ATTR_EPCS,
3450 
3451 	/* add attributes here, update the policy in nl80211.c */
3452 
3453 	__NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3454 	NUM_NL80211_ATTR = __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3455 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
3456 };
3457 
3458 /* source-level API compatibility */
3459 #define NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_GENERATION NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION
3460 #define	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG
3461 #define NL80211_ATTR_IFACE_SOCKET_OWNER NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER
3462 #define NL80211_ATTR_SAE_DATA NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA
3463 #define NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_BEACON NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON
3464 #define NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_PRESP NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP
3465 
3466 /*
3467  * Allow user space programs to use #ifdef on new attributes by defining them
3468  * here
3469  */
3470 #define NL80211_CMD_CONNECT NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
3471 #define NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY
3472 #define NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES
3473 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS
3474 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
3475 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE
3476 #define NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE
3477 #define NL80211_ATTR_IE NL80211_ATTR_IE
3478 #define NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR
3479 #define NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE
3480 #define NL80211_ATTR_FRAME NL80211_ATTR_FRAME
3481 #define NL80211_ATTR_SSID NL80211_ATTR_SSID
3482 #define NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE
3483 #define NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE
3484 #define NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE
3485 #define NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP
3486 #define NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS
3487 #define NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES
3488 #define NL80211_ATTR_KEY NL80211_ATTR_KEY
3489 #define NL80211_ATTR_KEYS NL80211_ATTR_KEYS
3490 #define NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS
3491 
3492 #define NL80211_WIPHY_NAME_MAXLEN		64
3493 
3494 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES			32
3495 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_SELECTORS		128
3496 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_HT_RATES		77
3497 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_REG_RULES		128
3498 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_ENCR_KEY	0
3499 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_TX_MIC_KEY	16
3500 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_RX_MIC_KEY	24
3501 #define NL80211_HT_CAPABILITY_LEN		26
3502 #define NL80211_VHT_CAPABILITY_LEN		12
3503 #define NL80211_HE_MIN_CAPABILITY_LEN           16
3504 #define NL80211_HE_MAX_CAPABILITY_LEN           54
3505 #define NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES		5
3506 
3507 /*
3508  * NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES is obsolete when %NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES
3509  * present in %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY response.
3510  */
3511 #define NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES		2
3512 #define NL80211_EHT_MIN_CAPABILITY_LEN          13
3513 #define NL80211_EHT_MAX_CAPABILITY_LEN          51
3514 
3515 #define NL80211_MIN_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_TIME	10
3516 
3517 /* default RSSI threshold for scan results if none specified. */
3518 #define NL80211_SCAN_RSSI_THOLD_OFF		-300
3519 
3520 #define NL80211_CQM_TXE_MAX_INTVL		1800
3521 
3522 /**
3523  * enum nl80211_iftype - (virtual) interface types
3524  *
3525  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_UNSPECIFIED: unspecified type, driver decides
3526  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_ADHOC: independent BSS member
3527  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION: managed BSS member
3528  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AP: access point
3529  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN: VLAN interface for access points; VLAN interfaces
3530  *	are a bit special in that they must always be tied to a pre-existing
3531  *	AP type interface.
3532  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_WDS: wireless distribution interface
3533  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MONITOR: monitor interface receiving all frames
3534  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT: mesh point
3535  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT: P2P client
3536  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO: P2P group owner
3537  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_DEVICE: P2P device interface type, this is not a netdev
3538  *	and therefore can't be created in the normal ways, use the
3539  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE and %NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE
3540  *	commands to create and destroy one
3541  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_OCB: Outside Context of a BSS
3542  *	This mode corresponds to the MIB variable dot11OCBActivated=true
3543  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_NAN: NAN device interface type (not a netdev)
3544  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX: highest interface type number currently defined
3545  * @NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES: number of defined interface types
3546  *
3547  * These values are used with the %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE
3548  * to set the type of an interface.
3549  *
3550  */
3551 enum nl80211_iftype {
3552 	NL80211_IFTYPE_UNSPECIFIED,
3553 	NL80211_IFTYPE_ADHOC,
3554 	NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION,
3555 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AP,
3556 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN,
3557 	NL80211_IFTYPE_WDS,
3558 	NL80211_IFTYPE_MONITOR,
3559 	NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT,
3560 	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT,
3561 	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO,
3562 	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_DEVICE,
3563 	NL80211_IFTYPE_OCB,
3564 	NL80211_IFTYPE_NAN,
3565 
3566 	/* keep last */
3567 	NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES,
3568 	NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES - 1
3569 };
3570 
3571 /**
3572  * enum nl80211_sta_flags - station flags
3573  *
3574  * Station flags. When a station is added to an AP interface, it is
3575  * assumed to be already associated (and hence authenticated.)
3576  *
3577  * @__NL80211_STA_FLAG_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3578  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
3579  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_SHORT_PREAMBLE: station is capable of receiving frames
3580  *	with short barker preamble
3581  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME: station is WME/QoS capable
3582  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_MFP: station uses management frame protection
3583  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHENTICATED: station is authenticated
3584  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER: station is a TDLS peer -- this flag should
3585  *	only be used in managed mode (even in the flags mask). Note that the
3586  *	flag can't be changed, it is only valid while adding a station, and
3587  *	attempts to change it will silently be ignored (rather than rejected
3588  *	as errors.)
3589  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_ASSOCIATED: station is associated; used with drivers
3590  *	that support %NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE to transition a
3591  *	previously added station into associated state
3592  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU: station supports SPP A-MSDUs
3593  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX: highest station flag number currently defined
3594  * @__NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3595  */
3596 enum nl80211_sta_flags {
3597 	__NL80211_STA_FLAG_INVALID,
3598 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED,
3599 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
3600 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME,
3601 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_MFP,
3602 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHENTICATED,
3603 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER,
3604 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_ASSOCIATED,
3605 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU,
3606 
3607 	/* keep last */
3608 	__NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST,
3609 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX = __NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST - 1
3610 };
3611 
3612 /**
3613  * enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status - station support of P2P PS
3614  *
3615  * @NL80211_P2P_PS_UNSUPPORTED: station doesn't support P2P PS mechanism
3616  * @NL80211_P2P_PS_SUPPORTED: station supports P2P PS mechanism
3617  * @NUM_NL80211_P2P_PS_STATUS: number of values
3618  */
3619 enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status {
3620 	NL80211_P2P_PS_UNSUPPORTED = 0,
3621 	NL80211_P2P_PS_SUPPORTED,
3622 
3623 	NUM_NL80211_P2P_PS_STATUS,
3624 };
3625 
3626 #define NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX_OLD_API	NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER
3627 
3628 /**
3629  * struct nl80211_sta_flag_update - station flags mask/set
3630  * @mask: mask of station flags to set
3631  * @set: which values to set them to
3632  *
3633  * Both mask and set contain bits as per &enum nl80211_sta_flags.
3634  */
3635 struct nl80211_sta_flag_update {
3636 	__u32 mask;
3637 	__u32 set;
3638 } __attribute__((packed));
3639 
3640 /**
3641  * enum nl80211_he_gi - HE guard interval
3642  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_0_8: 0.8 usec
3643  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_1_6: 1.6 usec
3644  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_3_2: 3.2 usec
3645  */
3646 enum nl80211_he_gi {
3647 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_0_8,
3648 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_1_6,
3649 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_3_2,
3650 };
3651 
3652 /**
3653  * enum nl80211_he_ltf - HE long training field
3654  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_1XLTF: 3.2 usec
3655  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_2XLTF: 6.4 usec
3656  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_4XLTF: 12.8 usec
3657  */
3658 enum nl80211_he_ltf {
3659 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_1XLTF,
3660 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_2XLTF,
3661 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_4XLTF,
3662 };
3663 
3664 /**
3665  * enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc - HE RU allocation values
3666  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_26: 26-tone RU allocation
3667  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_52: 52-tone RU allocation
3668  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_106: 106-tone RU allocation
3669  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_242: 242-tone RU allocation
3670  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_484: 484-tone RU allocation
3671  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_996: 996-tone RU allocation
3672  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_2x996: 2x996-tone RU allocation
3673  */
3674 enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc {
3675 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_26,
3676 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_52,
3677 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_106,
3678 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_242,
3679 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_484,
3680 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_996,
3681 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_2x996,
3682 };
3683 
3684 /**
3685  * enum nl80211_eht_gi - EHT guard interval
3686  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_0_8: 0.8 usec
3687  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_1_6: 1.6 usec
3688  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_3_2: 3.2 usec
3689  */
3690 enum nl80211_eht_gi {
3691 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_0_8,
3692 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_1_6,
3693 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_3_2,
3694 };
3695 
3696 /**
3697  * enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc - EHT RU allocation values
3698  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_26: 26-tone RU allocation
3699  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52: 52-tone RU allocation
3700  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52P26: 52+26-tone RU allocation
3701  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106: 106-tone RU allocation
3702  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106P26: 106+26 tone RU allocation
3703  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_242: 242-tone RU allocation
3704  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484: 484-tone RU allocation
3705  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484P242: 484+242 tone RU allocation
3706  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996: 996-tone RU allocation
3707  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484: 996+484 tone RU allocation
3708  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484P242: 996+484+242 tone RU allocation
3709  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996: 2x996-tone RU allocation
3710  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996P484: 2x996+484 tone RU allocation
3711  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996: 3x996-tone RU allocation
3712  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996P484: 3x996+484 tone RU allocation
3713  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_4x996: 4x996-tone RU allocation
3714  */
3715 enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc {
3716 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_26,
3717 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52,
3718 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52P26,
3719 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106,
3720 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106P26,
3721 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_242,
3722 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484,
3723 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484P242,
3724 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996,
3725 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484,
3726 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484P242,
3727 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996,
3728 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996P484,
3729 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996,
3730 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996P484,
3731 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_4x996,
3732 };
3733 
3734 /**
3735  * enum nl80211_rate_info - bitrate information
3736  *
3737  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_STA_INFO_TXRATE
3738  * when getting information about the bitrate of a station.
3739  * There are 2 attributes for bitrate, a legacy one that represents
3740  * a 16-bit value, and new one that represents a 32-bit value.
3741  * If the rate value fits into 16 bit, both attributes are reported
3742  * with the same value. If the rate is too high to fit into 16 bits
3743  * (>6.5535Gbps) only 32-bit attribute is included.
3744  * User space tools encouraged to use the 32-bit attribute and fall
3745  * back to the 16-bit one for compatibility with older kernels.
3746  *
3747  * @__NL80211_RATE_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3748  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE: total bitrate (u16, 100kbit/s)
3749  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_MCS: mcs index for 802.11n (u8)
3750  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_40_MHZ_WIDTH: 40 MHz dualchannel bitrate
3751  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval
3752  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE32: total bitrate (u32, 100kbit/s)
3753  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_MAX: highest rate_info number currently defined
3754  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_MCS: MCS index for VHT (u8)
3755  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_NSS: number of streams in VHT (u8)
3756  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_80_MHZ_WIDTH: 80 MHz VHT rate
3757  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_80P80_MHZ_WIDTH: unused - 80+80 is treated the
3758  *	same as 160 for purposes of the bitrates
3759  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_160_MHZ_WIDTH: 160 MHz VHT rate
3760  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_10_MHZ_WIDTH: 10 MHz width - note that this is
3761  *	a legacy rate and will be reported as the actual bitrate, i.e.
3762  *	half the base (20 MHz) rate
3763  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_5_MHZ_WIDTH: 5 MHz width - note that this is
3764  *	a legacy rate and will be reported as the actual bitrate, i.e.
3765  *	a quarter of the base (20 MHz) rate
3766  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_MCS: HE MCS index (u8, 0-11)
3767  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_NSS: HE NSS value (u8, 1-8)
3768  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI: HE guard interval identifier
3769  *	(u8, see &enum nl80211_he_gi)
3770  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_DCM: HE DCM value (u8, 0/1)
3771  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC: HE RU allocation, if not present then
3772  *	non-OFDMA was used (u8, see &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc)
3773  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_320_MHZ_WIDTH: 320 MHz bitrate
3774  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_MCS: EHT MCS index (u8, 0-15)
3775  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_NSS: EHT NSS value (u8, 1-8)
3776  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI: EHT guard interval identifier
3777  *	(u8, see &enum nl80211_eht_gi)
3778  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC: EHT RU allocation, if not present then
3779  *	non-OFDMA was used (u8, see &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc)
3780  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_MCS: S1G MCS index (u8, 0-10)
3781  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_NSS: S1G NSS value (u8, 1-4)
3782  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_1_MHZ_WIDTH: 1 MHz S1G rate
3783  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_2_MHZ_WIDTH: 2 MHz S1G rate
3784  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_4_MHZ_WIDTH: 4 MHz S1G rate
3785  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_8_MHZ_WIDTH: 8 MHz S1G rate
3786  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_16_MHZ_WIDTH: 16 MHz S1G rate
3787  * @__NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3788  */
3789 enum nl80211_rate_info {
3790 	__NL80211_RATE_INFO_INVALID,
3791 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE,
3792 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_MCS,
3793 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_40_MHZ_WIDTH,
3794 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_SHORT_GI,
3795 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE32,
3796 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_MCS,
3797 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_NSS,
3798 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_80_MHZ_WIDTH,
3799 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_80P80_MHZ_WIDTH,
3800 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_160_MHZ_WIDTH,
3801 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_10_MHZ_WIDTH,
3802 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_5_MHZ_WIDTH,
3803 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_MCS,
3804 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_NSS,
3805 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI,
3806 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_DCM,
3807 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC,
3808 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_320_MHZ_WIDTH,
3809 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_MCS,
3810 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_NSS,
3811 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI,
3812 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC,
3813 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_MCS,
3814 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_NSS,
3815 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_1_MHZ_WIDTH,
3816 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_2_MHZ_WIDTH,
3817 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_4_MHZ_WIDTH,
3818 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_8_MHZ_WIDTH,
3819 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_16_MHZ_WIDTH,
3820 
3821 	/* keep last */
3822 	__NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
3823 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
3824 };
3825 
3826 /**
3827  * enum nl80211_sta_bss_param - BSS information collected by STA
3828  *
3829  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM
3830  * when getting information about the bitrate of a station.
3831  *
3832  * @__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3833  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled (flag)
3834  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_PREAMBLE:  whether short preamble is enabled
3835  *	(flag)
3836  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_SLOT_TIME:  whether short slot time is enabled
3837  *	(flag)
3838  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_DTIM_PERIOD: DTIM period for beaconing (u8)
3839  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_BEACON_INTERVAL: Beacon interval (u16)
3840  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_MAX: highest sta_bss_param number currently defined
3841  * @__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3842  */
3843 enum nl80211_sta_bss_param {
3844 	__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_INVALID,
3845 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_CTS_PROT,
3846 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
3847 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_SLOT_TIME,
3848 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_DTIM_PERIOD,
3849 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_BEACON_INTERVAL,
3850 
3851 	/* keep last */
3852 	__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST,
3853 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_MAX = __NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST - 1
3854 };
3855 
3856 /**
3857  * enum nl80211_sta_info - station information
3858  *
3859  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO
3860  * when getting information about a station.
3861  *
3862  * @__NL80211_STA_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3863  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_INACTIVE_TIME: time since last activity (u32, msecs)
3864  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES: total received bytes (MPDU length)
3865  *	(u32, from this station)
3866  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES: total transmitted bytes (MPDU length)
3867  *	(u32, to this station)
3868  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES64: total received bytes (MPDU length)
3869  *	(u64, from this station)
3870  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES64: total transmitted bytes (MPDU length)
3871  *	(u64, to this station)
3872  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL: signal strength of last received PPDU (u8, dBm)
3873  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE: current unicast tx rate, nested attribute
3874  *	containing info as possible, see &enum nl80211_rate_info
3875  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_PACKETS: total received packet (MSDUs and MMPDUs)
3876  *	(u32, from this station)
3877  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_PACKETS: total transmitted packets (MSDUs and MMPDUs)
3878  *	(u32, to this station)
3879  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_RETRIES: total retries (MPDUs) (u32, to this station)
3880  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_FAILED: total failed packets (MPDUs)
3881  *	(u32, to this station)
3882  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL_AVG: signal strength average (u8, dBm)
3883  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_LLID: the station's mesh LLID
3884  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PLID: the station's mesh PLID
3885  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PLINK_STATE: peer link state for the station
3886  *	(see %enum nl80211_plink_state)
3887  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BITRATE: last unicast data frame rx rate, nested
3888  *	attribute, like NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE.
3889  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM: current station's view of BSS, nested attribute
3890  *     containing info as possible, see &enum nl80211_sta_bss_param
3891  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TIME: time since the station is last connected
3892  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_STA_FLAGS: Contains a struct nl80211_sta_flag_update.
3893  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_LOSS: count of times beacon loss was detected (u32)
3894  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_T_OFFSET: timing offset with respect to this STA (s64)
3895  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_LOCAL_PM: local mesh STA link-specific power mode
3896  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PEER_PM: peer mesh STA link-specific power mode
3897  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_NONPEER_PM: neighbor mesh STA power save mode towards
3898  *	non-peer STA
3899  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL: per-chain signal strength of last PPDU
3900  *	Contains a nested array of signal strength attributes (u8, dBm)
3901  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL_AVG: per-chain signal strength average
3902  *	Same format as NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL.
3903  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_EXPECTED_THROUGHPUT: expected throughput considering also
3904  *	the 802.11 header (u32, kbps)
3905  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DROP_MISC: RX packets dropped for unspecified reasons
3906  *	(u64)
3907  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_RX: number of beacons received from this peer (u64)
3908  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_SIGNAL_AVG: signal strength average
3909  *	for beacons only (u8, dBm)
3910  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TID_STATS: per-TID statistics (see &enum nl80211_tid_stats)
3911  *	This is a nested attribute where each the inner attribute number is the
3912  *	TID+1 and the special TID 16 (i.e. value 17) is used for non-QoS frames;
3913  *	each one of those is again nested with &enum nl80211_tid_stats
3914  *	attributes carrying the actual values.
3915  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DURATION: aggregate PPDU duration for all frames
3916  *	received from the station (u64, usec)
3917  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
3918  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL: signal strength of the last ACK frame(u8, dBm)
3919  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG: avg signal strength of ACK frames (s8, dBm)
3920  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_MPDUS: total number of received packets (MPDUs)
3921  *	(u32, from this station)
3922  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_FCS_ERROR_COUNT: total number of packets (MPDUs) received
3923  *	with an FCS error (u32, from this station). This count may not include
3924  *	some packets with an FCS error due to TA corruption. Hence this counter
3925  *	might not be fully accurate.
3926  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_GATE: set to true if STA has a path to a
3927  *	mesh gate (u8, 0 or 1)
3928  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_DURATION: aggregate PPDU duration for all frames
3929  *	sent to the station (u64, usec)
3930  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_WEIGHT: current airtime weight for station (u16)
3931  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_LINK_METRIC: airtime link metric for mesh station
3932  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ASSOC_AT_BOOTTIME: Timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME, nanoseconds)
3933  *	of STA's association
3934  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_AS: set to true if STA has a path to a
3935  *	authentication server (u8, 0 or 1)
3936  * @__NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal
3937  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_MAX: highest possible station info attribute
3938  */
3939 enum nl80211_sta_info {
3940 	__NL80211_STA_INFO_INVALID,
3941 	NL80211_STA_INFO_INACTIVE_TIME,
3942 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES,
3943 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES,
3944 	NL80211_STA_INFO_LLID,
3945 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PLID,
3946 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PLINK_STATE,
3947 	NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL,
3948 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE,
3949 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_PACKETS,
3950 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_PACKETS,
3951 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_RETRIES,
3952 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_FAILED,
3953 	NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL_AVG,
3954 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BITRATE,
3955 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM,
3956 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TIME,
3957 	NL80211_STA_INFO_STA_FLAGS,
3958 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_LOSS,
3959 	NL80211_STA_INFO_T_OFFSET,
3960 	NL80211_STA_INFO_LOCAL_PM,
3961 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PEER_PM,
3962 	NL80211_STA_INFO_NONPEER_PM,
3963 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES64,
3964 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES64,
3965 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL,
3966 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL_AVG,
3967 	NL80211_STA_INFO_EXPECTED_THROUGHPUT,
3968 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DROP_MISC,
3969 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_RX,
3970 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_SIGNAL_AVG,
3971 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TID_STATS,
3972 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DURATION,
3973 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PAD,
3974 	NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL,
3975 	NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG,
3976 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_MPDUS,
3977 	NL80211_STA_INFO_FCS_ERROR_COUNT,
3978 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_GATE,
3979 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_DURATION,
3980 	NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_WEIGHT,
3981 	NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_LINK_METRIC,
3982 	NL80211_STA_INFO_ASSOC_AT_BOOTTIME,
3983 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_AS,
3984 
3985 	/* keep last */
3986 	__NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
3987 	NL80211_STA_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
3988 };
3989 
3990 /* we renamed this - stay compatible */
3991 #define NL80211_STA_INFO_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG
3992 
3993 
3994 /**
3995  * enum nl80211_tid_stats - per TID statistics attributes
3996  * @__NL80211_TID_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3997  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_RX_MSDU: number of MSDUs received (u64)
3998  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU: number of MSDUs transmitted (or
3999  *	attempted to transmit; u64)
4000  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_RETRIES: number of retries for
4001  *	transmitted MSDUs (not counting the first attempt; u64)
4002  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_FAILED: number of failed transmitted
4003  *	MSDUs (u64)
4004  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
4005  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TXQ_STATS: TXQ stats (nested attribute)
4006  * @NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS: number of attributes here
4007  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_MAX: highest numbered attribute here
4008  */
4009 enum nl80211_tid_stats {
4010 	__NL80211_TID_STATS_INVALID,
4011 	NL80211_TID_STATS_RX_MSDU,
4012 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU,
4013 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_RETRIES,
4014 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_FAILED,
4015 	NL80211_TID_STATS_PAD,
4016 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TXQ_STATS,
4017 
4018 	/* keep last */
4019 	NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS,
4020 	NL80211_TID_STATS_MAX = NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS - 1
4021 };
4022 
4023 /**
4024  * enum nl80211_txq_stats - per TXQ statistics attributes
4025  * @__NL80211_TXQ_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4026  * @NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS: number of attributes here
4027  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_BYTES: number of bytes currently backlogged
4028  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_PACKETS: number of packets currently
4029  *      backlogged
4030  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_FLOWS: total number of new flows seen
4031  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_DROPS: total number of packet drops
4032  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_ECN_MARKS: total number of packet ECN marks
4033  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERLIMIT: number of drops due to queue space overflow
4034  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERMEMORY: number of drops due to memory limit overflow
4035  *      (only for per-phy stats)
4036  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_COLLISIONS: number of hash collisions
4037  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_BYTES: total number of bytes dequeued from TXQ
4038  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_PACKETS: total number of packets dequeued from TXQ
4039  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX_FLOWS: number of flow buckets for PHY
4040  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX: highest numbered attribute here
4041  */
4042 enum nl80211_txq_stats {
4043 	__NL80211_TXQ_STATS_INVALID,
4044 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_BYTES,
4045 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_PACKETS,
4046 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_FLOWS,
4047 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_DROPS,
4048 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_ECN_MARKS,
4049 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERLIMIT,
4050 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERMEMORY,
4051 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_COLLISIONS,
4052 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_BYTES,
4053 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_PACKETS,
4054 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX_FLOWS,
4055 
4056 	/* keep last */
4057 	NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS,
4058 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX = NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS - 1
4059 };
4060 
4061 /**
4062  * enum nl80211_mpath_flags - nl80211 mesh path flags
4063  *
4064  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_ACTIVE: the mesh path is active
4065  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVING: the mesh path discovery process is running
4066  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_SN_VALID: the mesh path contains a valid SN
4067  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_FIXED: the mesh path has been manually set
4068  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVED: the mesh path discovery process succeeded
4069  */
4070 enum nl80211_mpath_flags {
4071 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_ACTIVE =	1<<0,
4072 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVING =	1<<1,
4073 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_SN_VALID =	1<<2,
4074 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_FIXED =	1<<3,
4075 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVED =	1<<4,
4076 };
4077 
4078 /**
4079  * enum nl80211_mpath_info - mesh path information
4080  *
4081  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO when getting
4082  * information about a mesh path.
4083  *
4084  * @__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4085  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: number of queued frames for this destination
4086  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_SN: destination sequence number
4087  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_METRIC: metric (cost) of this mesh path
4088  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: expiration time for the path, in msec from now
4089  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: mesh path flags, enumerated in
4090  *	&enum nl80211_mpath_flags;
4091  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: total path discovery timeout, in msec
4092  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: mesh path discovery retries
4093  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: hop count to destination
4094  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: total number of path changes to destination
4095  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_MAX: highest mesh path information attribute number
4096  *	currently defined
4097  * @__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4098  */
4099 enum nl80211_mpath_info {
4100 	__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_INVALID,
4101 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN,
4102 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_SN,
4103 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_METRIC,
4104 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME,
4105 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FLAGS,
4106 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT,
4107 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES,
4108 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT,
4109 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE,
4110 
4111 	/* keep last */
4112 	__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
4113 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
4114 };
4115 
4116 /**
4117  * enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr - Interface type data attributes
4118  *
4119  * @__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4120  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing a flag attribute
4121  *     for each interface type that supports the band data
4122  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MAC: HE MAC capabilities as in HE
4123  *     capabilities IE
4124  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PHY: HE PHY capabilities as in HE
4125  *     capabilities IE
4126  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MCS_SET: HE supported NSS/MCS as in HE
4127  *     capabilities IE
4128  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PPE: HE PPE thresholds information as
4129  *     defined in HE capabilities IE
4130  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPA: HE 6GHz band capabilities (__le16),
4131  *	given for all 6 GHz band channels
4132  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_VENDOR_ELEMS: vendor element capabilities that are
4133  *	advertised on this band/for this iftype (binary)
4134  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MAC: EHT MAC capabilities as in EHT
4135  *	capabilities element
4136  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PHY: EHT PHY capabilities as in EHT
4137  *	capabilities element
4138  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MCS_SET: EHT supported NSS/MCS as in EHT
4139  *	capabilities element
4140  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PPE: EHT PPE thresholds information as
4141  *	defined in EHT capabilities element
4142  * @__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4143  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_MAX: highest band attribute currently defined
4144  */
4145 enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr {
4146 	__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_INVALID,
4147 
4148 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_IFTYPES,
4149 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MAC,
4150 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PHY,
4151 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MCS_SET,
4152 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PPE,
4153 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPA,
4154 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_VENDOR_ELEMS,
4155 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MAC,
4156 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PHY,
4157 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MCS_SET,
4158 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PPE,
4159 
4160 	/* keep last */
4161 	__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4162 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4163 };
4164 
4165 /**
4166  * enum nl80211_band_attr - band attributes
4167  * @__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4168  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_FREQS: supported frequencies in this band,
4169  *	an array of nested frequency attributes
4170  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_RATES: supported bitrates in this band,
4171  *	an array of nested bitrate attributes
4172  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_MCS_SET: 16-byte attribute containing the MCS set as
4173  *	defined in 802.11n
4174  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA: HT capabilities, as in the HT information IE
4175  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_FACTOR: A-MPDU factor, as in 11n
4176  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_DENSITY: A-MPDU density, as in 11n
4177  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_MCS_SET: 32-byte attribute containing the MCS set as
4178  *	defined in 802.11ac
4179  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_CAPA: VHT capabilities, as in the HT information IE
4180  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_IFTYPE_DATA: nested array attribute, with each entry using
4181  *	attributes from &enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr
4182  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_CHANNELS: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz
4183  *	channel(s) that are allowed to be used for EDMG transmissions.
4184  *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251.
4185  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_BW_CONFIG: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
4186  *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations.
4187  *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251, Table 13.
4188  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_MCS_NSS_SET: S1G capabilities, supported S1G-MCS and NSS
4189  *	set subfield, as in the S1G information IE, 5 bytes
4190  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_CAPA: S1G capabilities information subfield as in the
4191  *	S1G information IE, 10 bytes
4192  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_MAX: highest band attribute currently defined
4193  * @__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4194  */
4195 enum nl80211_band_attr {
4196 	__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_INVALID,
4197 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_FREQS,
4198 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_RATES,
4199 
4200 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_MCS_SET,
4201 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA,
4202 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_FACTOR,
4203 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_DENSITY,
4204 
4205 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_MCS_SET,
4206 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_CAPA,
4207 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_IFTYPE_DATA,
4208 
4209 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_CHANNELS,
4210 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_BW_CONFIG,
4211 
4212 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_MCS_NSS_SET,
4213 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_CAPA,
4214 
4215 	/* keep last */
4216 	__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4217 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4218 };
4219 
4220 #define NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA
4221 
4222 /**
4223  * enum nl80211_wmm_rule - regulatory wmm rule
4224  *
4225  * @__NL80211_WMMR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4226  * @NL80211_WMMR_CW_MIN: Minimum contention window slot.
4227  * @NL80211_WMMR_CW_MAX: Maximum contention window slot.
4228  * @NL80211_WMMR_AIFSN: Arbitration Inter Frame Space.
4229  * @NL80211_WMMR_TXOP: Maximum allowed tx operation time.
4230  * @NL80211_WMMR_MAX: highest possible wmm rule.
4231  * @__NL80211_WMMR_LAST: Internal use.
4232  */
4233 enum nl80211_wmm_rule {
4234 	__NL80211_WMMR_INVALID,
4235 	NL80211_WMMR_CW_MIN,
4236 	NL80211_WMMR_CW_MAX,
4237 	NL80211_WMMR_AIFSN,
4238 	NL80211_WMMR_TXOP,
4239 
4240 	/* keep last */
4241 	__NL80211_WMMR_LAST,
4242 	NL80211_WMMR_MAX = __NL80211_WMMR_LAST - 1
4243 };
4244 
4245 /**
4246  * enum nl80211_frequency_attr - frequency attributes
4247  * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4248  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_FREQ: Frequency in MHz
4249  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DISABLED: Channel is disabled in current
4250  *	regulatory domain.
4251  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR: no mechanisms that initiate radiation
4252  *	are permitted on this channel, this includes sending probe
4253  *	requests, or modes of operation that require beaconing.
4254  * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS: obsolete, same as _NO_IR
4255  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_RADAR: Radar detection is mandatory
4256  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4257  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER: Maximum transmission power in mBm
4258  *	(100 * dBm).
4259  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_STATE: current state for DFS
4260  *	(enum nl80211_dfs_state)
4261  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_TIME: time in milliseconds for how long
4262  *	this channel is in this DFS state.
4263  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_MINUS: HT40- isn't possible with this
4264  *	channel as the control channel
4265  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_PLUS: HT40+ isn't possible with this
4266  *	channel as the control channel
4267  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_80MHZ: any 80 MHz channel using this channel
4268  *	as the primary or any of the secondary channels isn't possible,
4269  *	this includes 80+80 channels
4270  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_160MHZ: any 160 MHz (but not 80+80) channel
4271  *	using this channel as the primary or any of the secondary channels
4272  *	isn't possible
4273  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME: DFS CAC time in milliseconds.
4274  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY: Only indoor use is permitted on this
4275  *	channel. A channel that has the INDOOR_ONLY attribute can only be
4276  *	used when there is a clear assessment that the device is operating in
4277  *	an indoor surroundings, i.e., it is connected to AC power (and not
4278  *	through portable DC inverters) or is under the control of a master
4279  *	that is acting as an AP and is connected to AC power.
4280  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT: IR operation is allowed on this
4281  *	channel if it's connected concurrently to a BSS on the same channel on
4282  *	the 2 GHz band or to a channel in the same UNII band (on the 5 GHz
4283  *	band), and IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR is not set. Instantiating a GO or TDLS
4284  *	off-channel on a channel that has the IR_CONCURRENT attribute set can be
4285  *	done when there is a clear assessment that the device is operating under
4286  *	the guidance of an authorized master, i.e., setting up a GO or TDLS
4287  *	off-channel while the device is also connected to an AP with DFS and
4288  *	radar detection on the UNII band (it is up to user-space, i.e.,
4289  *	wpa_supplicant to perform the required verifications). Using this
4290  *	attribute for IR is disallowed for master interfaces (IBSS, AP).
4291  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz operation is not allowed
4292  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4293  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz operation is not allowed
4294  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4295  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_WMM: this channel has wmm limitations.
4296  *	This is a nested attribute that contains the wmm limitation per AC.
4297  *	(see &enum nl80211_wmm_rule)
4298  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HE: HE operation is not allowed on this channel
4299  *	in current regulatory domain.
4300  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_OFFSET: frequency offset in KHz
4301  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_1MHZ: 1 MHz operation is allowed
4302  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4303  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_2MHZ: 2 MHz operation is allowed
4304  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4305  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_4MHZ: 4 MHz operation is allowed
4306  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4307  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_8MHZ: 8 MHz operation is allowed
4308  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4309  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_16MHZ: 16 MHz operation is allowed
4310  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4311  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_320MHZ: any 320 MHz channel using this channel
4312  *	as the primary or any of the secondary channels isn't possible
4313  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_EHT: EHT operation is not allowed on this channel
4314  *	in current regulatory domain.
4315  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_PSD: Power spectral density (in dBm) that
4316  *	is allowed on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4317  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CONCURRENT: Operation on this channel is
4318  *	allowed for peer-to-peer or adhoc communication under the control
4319  *	of a DFS master which operates on the same channel (FCC-594280 D01
4320  *	Section B.3). Should be used together with %NL80211_RRF_DFS only.
4321  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT: Client connection to VLP AP
4322  *	not allowed using this channel
4323  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT: Client connection to AFC AP
4324  *	not allowed using this channel
4325  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_CAN_MONITOR: This channel can be used in monitor
4326  *	mode despite other (regulatory) restrictions, even if the channel is
4327  *	otherwise completely disabled.
4328  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_ALLOW_6GHZ_VLP_AP: This channel can be used for a
4329  *	very low power (VLP) AP, despite being NO_IR.
4330  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX: highest frequency attribute number
4331  *	currently defined
4332  * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4333  *
4334  * See https://apps.fcc.gov/eas/comments/GetPublishedDocument.html?id=327&tn=528122
4335  * for more information on the FCC description of the relaxations allowed
4336  * by NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY and
4337  * NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT.
4338  */
4339 enum nl80211_frequency_attr {
4340 	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INVALID,
4341 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_FREQ,
4342 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DISABLED,
4343 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR,
4344 	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS,
4345 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_RADAR,
4346 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER,
4347 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_STATE,
4348 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_TIME,
4349 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_MINUS,
4350 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_PLUS,
4351 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_80MHZ,
4352 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_160MHZ,
4353 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME,
4354 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY,
4355 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT,
4356 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_20MHZ,
4357 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_10MHZ,
4358 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_WMM,
4359 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HE,
4360 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_OFFSET,
4361 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_1MHZ,
4362 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_2MHZ,
4363 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_4MHZ,
4364 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_8MHZ,
4365 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_16MHZ,
4366 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_320MHZ,
4367 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_EHT,
4368 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_PSD,
4369 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CONCURRENT,
4370 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT,
4371 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT,
4372 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_CAN_MONITOR,
4373 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_ALLOW_6GHZ_VLP_AP,
4374 
4375 	/* keep last */
4376 	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4377 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4378 };
4379 
4380 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER
4381 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_PASSIVE_SCAN	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
4382 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS		NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
4383 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR		NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
4384 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_GO_CONCURRENT \
4385 					NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
4386 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_UHB_VLP_CLIENT \
4387 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT
4388 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_UHB_AFC_CLIENT \
4389 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT
4390 
4391 /**
4392  * enum nl80211_bitrate_attr - bitrate attributes
4393  * @__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4394  * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_RATE: Bitrate in units of 100 kbps
4395  * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_2GHZ_SHORTPREAMBLE: Short preamble supported
4396  *	in 2.4 GHz band.
4397  * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_MAX: highest bitrate attribute number
4398  *	currently defined
4399  * @__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4400  */
4401 enum nl80211_bitrate_attr {
4402 	__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_INVALID,
4403 	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_RATE,
4404 	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_2GHZ_SHORTPREAMBLE,
4405 
4406 	/* keep last */
4407 	__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4408 	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4409 };
4410 
4411 /**
4412  * enum nl80211_reg_initiator - Indicates the initiator of a reg domain request
4413  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_CORE: Core queried CRDA for a dynamic world
4414  *	regulatory domain.
4415  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_USER: User asked the wireless core to set the
4416  *	regulatory domain.
4417  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER: a wireless drivers has hinted to the
4418  *	wireless core it thinks its knows the regulatory domain we should be in.
4419  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE: the wireless core has received an
4420  *	802.11 country information element with regulatory information it
4421  *	thinks we should consider. cfg80211 only processes the country
4422  *	code from the IE, and relies on the regulatory domain information
4423  *	structure passed by userspace (CRDA) from our wireless-regdb.
4424  *	If a channel is enabled but the country code indicates it should
4425  *	be disabled we disable the channel and re-enable it upon disassociation.
4426  */
4427 enum nl80211_reg_initiator {
4428 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_CORE,
4429 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_USER,
4430 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER,
4431 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE,
4432 };
4433 
4434 /**
4435  * enum nl80211_reg_type - specifies the type of regulatory domain
4436  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_COUNTRY: the regulatory domain set is one that pertains
4437  *	to a specific country. When this is set you can count on the
4438  *	ISO / IEC 3166 alpha2 country code being valid.
4439  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_WORLD: the regulatory set domain is the world regulatory
4440  *	domain.
4441  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_CUSTOM_WORLD: the regulatory domain set is a custom
4442  *	driver specific world regulatory domain. These do not apply system-wide
4443  *	and are only applicable to the individual devices which have requested
4444  *	them to be applied.
4445  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_INTERSECTION: the regulatory domain set is the product
4446  *	of an intersection between two regulatory domains -- the previously
4447  *	set regulatory domain on the system and the last accepted regulatory
4448  *	domain request to be processed.
4449  */
4450 enum nl80211_reg_type {
4451 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_COUNTRY,
4452 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_WORLD,
4453 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_CUSTOM_WORLD,
4454 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_INTERSECTION,
4455 };
4456 
4457 /**
4458  * enum nl80211_reg_rule_attr - regulatory rule attributes
4459  * @__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4460  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS: a set of flags which specify additional
4461  *	considerations for a given frequency range. These are the
4462  *	&enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags.
4463  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_START: starting frequencry for the regulatory
4464  *	rule in KHz. This is not a center of frequency but an actual regulatory
4465  *	band edge.
4466  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_END: ending frequency for the regulatory rule
4467  *	in KHz. This is not a center a frequency but an actual regulatory
4468  *	band edge.
4469  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW: maximum allowed bandwidth for this
4470  *	frequency range, in KHz.
4471  * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_ANT_GAIN: the maximum allowed antenna gain
4472  *	for a given frequency range. The value is in mBi (100 * dBi).
4473  *	If you don't have one then don't send this.
4474  * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_EIRP: the maximum allowed EIRP for
4475  *	a given frequency range. The value is in mBm (100 * dBm).
4476  * @NL80211_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME: DFS CAC time in milliseconds.
4477  *	If not present or 0 default CAC time will be used.
4478  * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_PSD: power spectral density (in dBm).
4479  *	This could be negative.
4480  * @NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_MAX: highest regulatory rule attribute number
4481  *	currently defined
4482  * @__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4483  */
4484 enum nl80211_reg_rule_attr {
4485 	__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_INVALID,
4486 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS,
4487 
4488 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_START,
4489 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_END,
4490 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW,
4491 
4492 	NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_ANT_GAIN,
4493 	NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_EIRP,
4494 
4495 	NL80211_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME,
4496 
4497 	NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_PSD,
4498 
4499 	/* keep last */
4500 	__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4501 	NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4502 };
4503 
4504 /**
4505  * enum nl80211_sched_scan_match_attr - scheduled scan match attributes
4506  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4507  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID: SSID to be used for matching,
4508  *	only report BSS with matching SSID.
4509  *	(This cannot be used together with BSSID.)
4510  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI: RSSI threshold (in dBm) for reporting a
4511  *	BSS in scan results. Filtering is turned off if not specified. Note that
4512  *	if this attribute is in a match set of its own, then it is treated as
4513  *	the default value for all matchsets with an SSID, rather than being a
4514  *	matchset of its own without an RSSI filter. This is due to problems with
4515  *	how this API was implemented in the past. Also, due to the same problem,
4516  *	the only way to create a matchset with only an RSSI filter (with this
4517  *	attribute) is if there's only a single matchset with the RSSI attribute.
4518  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RELATIVE_RSSI: Flag indicating whether
4519  *	%NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI to be used as absolute RSSI or
4520  *	relative to current bss's RSSI.
4521  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for
4522  *	BSS-es in the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
4523  *	RSSI-based BSS selection. The attribute value is a packed structure
4524  *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
4525  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_BSSID: BSSID to be used for matching
4526  *	(this cannot be used together with SSID).
4527  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_PER_BAND_RSSI: Obsolete
4528  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX: highest scheduled scan filter
4529  *	attribute number currently defined
4530  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4531  */
4532 enum nl80211_sched_scan_match_attr {
4533 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_INVALID,
4534 
4535 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID,
4536 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI,
4537 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RELATIVE_RSSI,
4538 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST,
4539 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_BSSID,
4540 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_PER_BAND_RSSI, /* obsolete */
4541 
4542 	/* keep last */
4543 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4544 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX =
4545 		__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4546 };
4547 
4548 /* only for backward compatibility */
4549 #define NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_SSID NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID
4550 
4551 /**
4552  * enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags - regulatory rule flags
4553  *
4554  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_OFDM: OFDM modulation not allowed
4555  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_CCK: CCK modulation not allowed
4556  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_INDOOR: indoor operation not allowed
4557  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_OUTDOOR: outdoor operation not allowed
4558  * @NL80211_RRF_DFS: DFS support is required to be used
4559  * @NL80211_RRF_PTP_ONLY: this is only for Point To Point links
4560  * @NL80211_RRF_PTMP_ONLY: this is only for Point To Multi Point links
4561  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_IR: no mechanisms that initiate radiation are allowed,
4562  *	this includes probe requests or modes of operation that require
4563  *	beaconing.
4564  * @__NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS: obsolete, same as NO_IR
4565  * @NL80211_RRF_AUTO_BW: maximum available bandwidth should be calculated
4566  *	base on contiguous rules and wider channels will be allowed to cross
4567  *	multiple contiguous/overlapping frequency ranges.
4568  * @NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT: See %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
4569  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS: channels can't be used in HT40- operation
4570  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS: channels can't be used in HT40+ operation
4571  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_80MHZ: 80MHz operation not allowed
4572  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_160MHZ: 160MHz operation not allowed
4573  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HE: HE operation not allowed
4574  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_320MHZ: 320MHz operation not allowed
4575  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_EHT: EHT operation not allowed
4576  * @NL80211_RRF_PSD: Ruleset has power spectral density value
4577  * @NL80211_RRF_DFS_CONCURRENT: Operation on this channel is allowed for
4578  *	peer-to-peer or adhoc communication under the control of a DFS master
4579  *	which operates on the same channel (FCC-594280 D01 Section B.3).
4580  *	Should be used together with %NL80211_RRF_DFS only.
4581  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT: Client connection to VLP AP not allowed
4582  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT: Client connection to AFC AP not allowed
4583  * @NL80211_RRF_ALLOW_6GHZ_VLP_AP: Very low power (VLP) AP can be permitted
4584  *	despite NO_IR configuration.
4585  */
4586 enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags {
4587 	NL80211_RRF_NO_OFDM		= 1<<0,
4588 	NL80211_RRF_NO_CCK		= 1<<1,
4589 	NL80211_RRF_NO_INDOOR		= 1<<2,
4590 	NL80211_RRF_NO_OUTDOOR		= 1<<3,
4591 	NL80211_RRF_DFS			= 1<<4,
4592 	NL80211_RRF_PTP_ONLY		= 1<<5,
4593 	NL80211_RRF_PTMP_ONLY		= 1<<6,
4594 	NL80211_RRF_NO_IR		= 1<<7,
4595 	__NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS		= 1<<8,
4596 	NL80211_RRF_AUTO_BW		= 1<<11,
4597 	NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT	= 1<<12,
4598 	NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS	= 1<<13,
4599 	NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS		= 1<<14,
4600 	NL80211_RRF_NO_80MHZ		= 1<<15,
4601 	NL80211_RRF_NO_160MHZ		= 1<<16,
4602 	NL80211_RRF_NO_HE		= 1<<17,
4603 	NL80211_RRF_NO_320MHZ		= 1<<18,
4604 	NL80211_RRF_NO_EHT		= 1<<19,
4605 	NL80211_RRF_PSD			= 1<<20,
4606 	NL80211_RRF_DFS_CONCURRENT	= 1<<21,
4607 	NL80211_RRF_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT	= 1<<22,
4608 	NL80211_RRF_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT	= 1<<23,
4609 	NL80211_RRF_ALLOW_6GHZ_VLP_AP	= 1<<24,
4610 };
4611 
4612 #define NL80211_RRF_PASSIVE_SCAN	NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
4613 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS		NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
4614 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IR		NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
4615 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40		(NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS |\
4616 					 NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS)
4617 #define NL80211_RRF_GO_CONCURRENT	NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT
4618 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_UHB_VLP_CLIENT	NL80211_RRF_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT
4619 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_UHB_AFC_CLIENT	NL80211_RRF_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT
4620 
4621 /* For backport compatibility with older userspace */
4622 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IR_ALL		(NL80211_RRF_NO_IR | __NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS)
4623 
4624 /**
4625  * enum nl80211_dfs_regions - regulatory DFS regions
4626  *
4627  * @NL80211_DFS_UNSET: Country has no DFS master region specified
4628  * @NL80211_DFS_FCC: Country follows DFS master rules from FCC
4629  * @NL80211_DFS_ETSI: Country follows DFS master rules from ETSI
4630  * @NL80211_DFS_JP: Country follows DFS master rules from JP/MKK/Telec
4631  */
4632 enum nl80211_dfs_regions {
4633 	NL80211_DFS_UNSET	= 0,
4634 	NL80211_DFS_FCC		= 1,
4635 	NL80211_DFS_ETSI	= 2,
4636 	NL80211_DFS_JP		= 3,
4637 };
4638 
4639 /**
4640  * enum nl80211_user_reg_hint_type - type of user regulatory hint
4641  *
4642  * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_USER: a user sent the hint. This is always
4643  *	assumed if the attribute is not set.
4644  * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_CELL_BASE: the hint comes from a cellular
4645  *	base station. Device drivers that have been tested to work
4646  *	properly to support this type of hint can enable these hints
4647  *	by setting the NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS feature
4648  *	capability on the struct wiphy. The wireless core will
4649  *	ignore all cell base station hints until at least one device
4650  *	present has been registered with the wireless core that
4651  *	has listed NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS as a
4652  *	supported feature.
4653  * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_INDOOR: a user sent an hint indicating that the
4654  *	platform is operating in an indoor environment.
4655  */
4656 enum nl80211_user_reg_hint_type {
4657 	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_USER	= 0,
4658 	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_CELL_BASE = 1,
4659 	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_INDOOR    = 2,
4660 };
4661 
4662 /**
4663  * enum nl80211_survey_info - survey information
4664  *
4665  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO
4666  * when getting information about a survey.
4667  *
4668  * @__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4669  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY: center frequency of channel
4670  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_NOISE: noise level of channel (u8, dBm)
4671  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used
4672  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME: amount of time (in ms) that the radio
4673  *	was turned on (on channel or globally)
4674  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: amount of the time the primary
4675  *	channel was sensed busy (either due to activity or energy detect)
4676  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: amount of time the extension
4677  *	channel was sensed busy
4678  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: amount of time the radio spent
4679  *	receiving data (on channel or globally)
4680  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: amount of time the radio spent
4681  *	transmitting data (on channel or globally)
4682  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: time the radio spent for scan
4683  *	(on this channel or globally)
4684  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
4685  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: amount of time the radio spent
4686  *	receiving frames destined to the local BSS
4687  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_MAX: highest survey info attribute number
4688  *	currently defined
4689  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY_OFFSET: center frequency offset in KHz
4690  * @__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4691  */
4692 enum nl80211_survey_info {
4693 	__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_INVALID,
4694 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY,
4695 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_NOISE,
4696 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE,
4697 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME,
4698 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY,
4699 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY,
4700 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX,
4701 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX,
4702 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN,
4703 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_PAD,
4704 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX,
4705 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY_OFFSET,
4706 
4707 	/* keep last */
4708 	__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
4709 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
4710 };
4711 
4712 /* keep old names for compatibility */
4713 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME
4714 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_BUSY		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY
4715 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_EXT_BUSY	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY
4716 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_RX		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX
4717 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_TX		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX
4718 
4719 /**
4720  * enum nl80211_mntr_flags - monitor configuration flags
4721  *
4722  * Monitor configuration flags.
4723  *
4724  * @__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID: reserved
4725  *
4726  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS
4727  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP
4728  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames
4729  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering
4730  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing.
4731  *	overrides all other flags.
4732  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE: use the configured MAC address
4733  *	and ACK incoming unicast packets.
4734  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_SKIP_TX: do not pass local tx packets
4735  *
4736  * @__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4737  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_MAX: highest possible monitor flag
4738  */
4739 enum nl80211_mntr_flags {
4740 	__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID,
4741 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL,
4742 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL,
4743 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL,
4744 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS,
4745 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES,
4746 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE,
4747 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_SKIP_TX,
4748 
4749 	/* keep last */
4750 	__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST,
4751 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_MAX = __NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST - 1
4752 };
4753 
4754 /**
4755  * enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode - mesh power save modes
4756  *
4757  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_UNKNOWN: The mesh power mode of the mesh STA is
4758  *	not known or has not been set yet.
4759  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_ACTIVE: Active mesh power mode. The mesh STA is
4760  *	in Awake state all the time.
4761  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_LIGHT_SLEEP: Light sleep mode. The mesh STA will
4762  *	alternate between Active and Doze states, but will wake up for
4763  *	neighbor's beacons.
4764  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_DEEP_SLEEP: Deep sleep mode. The mesh STA will
4765  *	alternate between Active and Doze states, but may not wake up
4766  *	for neighbor's beacons.
4767  *
4768  * @__NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4769  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_MAX: highest possible power save level
4770  */
4771 
4772 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode {
4773 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_UNKNOWN,
4774 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_ACTIVE,
4775 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_LIGHT_SLEEP,
4776 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_DEEP_SLEEP,
4777 
4778 	__NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST,
4779 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_MAX = __NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST - 1
4780 };
4781 
4782 /**
4783  * enum nl80211_meshconf_params - mesh configuration parameters
4784  *
4785  * Mesh configuration parameters. These can be changed while the mesh is
4786  * active.
4787  *
4788  * @__NL80211_MESHCONF_INVALID: internal use
4789  *
4790  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_RETRY_TIMEOUT: specifies the initial retry timeout in
4791  *	millisecond units, used by the Peer Link Open message
4792  *
4793  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONFIRM_TIMEOUT: specifies the initial confirm timeout, in
4794  *	millisecond units, used by the peer link management to close a peer link
4795  *
4796  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HOLDING_TIMEOUT: specifies the holding timeout, in
4797  *	millisecond units
4798  *
4799  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_PEER_LINKS: maximum number of peer links allowed
4800  *	on this mesh interface
4801  *
4802  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_RETRIES: specifies the maximum number of peer link
4803  *	open retries that can be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a
4804  *	mesh
4805  *
4806  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_TTL: specifies the value of TTL field set at a source mesh
4807  *	point.
4808  *
4809  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_AUTO_OPEN_PLINKS: whether we should automatically open
4810  *	peer links when we detect compatible mesh peers. Disabled if
4811  *	@NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM or @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE are
4812  *	set.
4813  *
4814  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_MAX_PREQ_RETRIES: the number of action frames
4815  *	containing a PREQ that an MP can send to a particular destination (path
4816  *	target)
4817  *
4818  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_PATH_REFRESH_TIME: how frequently to refresh mesh paths
4819  *	(in milliseconds)
4820  *
4821  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MIN_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: minimum length of time to wait
4822  *	until giving up on a path discovery (in milliseconds)
4823  *
4824  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ACTIVE_PATH_TIMEOUT: The time (in TUs) for which mesh
4825  *	points receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from
4826  *	the root to be valid. (TU = time unit)
4827  *
4828  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PREQ_MIN_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time (in
4829  *	TUs) during which an MP can send only one action frame containing a PREQ
4830  *	reference element
4831  *
4832  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_NET_DIAM_TRVS_TIME: The interval of time (in TUs)
4833  *	that it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the
4834  *	mesh
4835  *
4836  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOTMODE: whether root mode is enabled or not
4837  *
4838  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_ELEMENT_TTL: specifies the value of TTL field set at a
4839  *	source mesh point for path selection elements.
4840  *
4841  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_RANN_INTERVAL:  The interval of time (in TUs) between
4842  *	root announcements are transmitted.
4843  *
4844  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_GATE_ANNOUNCEMENTS: Advertise that this mesh station has
4845  *	access to a broader network beyond the MBSS.  This is done via Root
4846  *	Announcement frames.
4847  *
4848  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PERR_MIN_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time (in
4849  *	TUs) during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a
4850  *	PERR element.
4851  *
4852  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_FORWARDING: set Mesh STA as forwarding or non-forwarding
4853  *	or forwarding entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity)
4854  *
4855  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_RSSI_THRESHOLD: RSSI threshold in dBm. This specifies the
4856  *	threshold for average signal strength of candidate station to establish
4857  *	a peer link.
4858  *
4859  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_SYNC_OFFSET_MAX_NEIGHBOR: maximum number of neighbors
4860  *	to synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method
4861  *	(see 11C.12.2.2)
4862  *
4863  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HT_OPMODE: set mesh HT protection mode.
4864  *
4865  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_MAX: highest possible mesh configuration attribute
4866  *
4867  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PATH_TO_ROOT_TIMEOUT: The time (in TUs) for
4868  *	which mesh STAs receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding
4869  *	information to the root mesh STA to be valid.
4870  *
4871  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOT_INTERVAL: The interval of time (in TUs) between
4872  *	proactive PREQs are transmitted.
4873  *
4874  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_CONFIRMATION_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time
4875  *	(in TUs) during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame
4876  *	containing a PREQ element for root path confirmation.
4877  *
4878  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_POWER_MODE: Default mesh power mode for new peer links.
4879  *	type &enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode (u32)
4880  *
4881  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_AWAKE_WINDOW: awake window duration (in TUs)
4882  *
4883  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've
4884  *	established peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then
4885  *	remove it from the STA's list of peers. You may set this to 0 to disable
4886  *	the removal of the STA. Default is 30 minutes.
4887  *
4888  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_GATE: If set to true then this mesh STA
4889  *	will advertise that it is connected to a gate in the mesh formation
4890  *	field.  If left unset then the mesh formation field will only
4891  *	advertise such if there is an active root mesh path.
4892  *
4893  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_NOLEARN: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g.
4894  *      PREQ/PREP for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that
4895  *      this might not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be
4896  *      better. So if using this setting you will likely also want to disable
4897  *      dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top.
4898  *
4899  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_AS: If set to true then this mesh STA
4900  *	will advertise that it is connected to a authentication server
4901  *	in the mesh formation field.
4902  *
4903  * @__NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4904  */
4905 enum nl80211_meshconf_params {
4906 	__NL80211_MESHCONF_INVALID,
4907 	NL80211_MESHCONF_RETRY_TIMEOUT,
4908 	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONFIRM_TIMEOUT,
4909 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HOLDING_TIMEOUT,
4910 	NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_PEER_LINKS,
4911 	NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_RETRIES,
4912 	NL80211_MESHCONF_TTL,
4913 	NL80211_MESHCONF_AUTO_OPEN_PLINKS,
4914 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_MAX_PREQ_RETRIES,
4915 	NL80211_MESHCONF_PATH_REFRESH_TIME,
4916 	NL80211_MESHCONF_MIN_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT,
4917 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ACTIVE_PATH_TIMEOUT,
4918 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PREQ_MIN_INTERVAL,
4919 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_NET_DIAM_TRVS_TIME,
4920 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOTMODE,
4921 	NL80211_MESHCONF_ELEMENT_TTL,
4922 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_RANN_INTERVAL,
4923 	NL80211_MESHCONF_GATE_ANNOUNCEMENTS,
4924 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PERR_MIN_INTERVAL,
4925 	NL80211_MESHCONF_FORWARDING,
4926 	NL80211_MESHCONF_RSSI_THRESHOLD,
4927 	NL80211_MESHCONF_SYNC_OFFSET_MAX_NEIGHBOR,
4928 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HT_OPMODE,
4929 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PATH_TO_ROOT_TIMEOUT,
4930 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOT_INTERVAL,
4931 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_CONFIRMATION_INTERVAL,
4932 	NL80211_MESHCONF_POWER_MODE,
4933 	NL80211_MESHCONF_AWAKE_WINDOW,
4934 	NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT,
4935 	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_GATE,
4936 	NL80211_MESHCONF_NOLEARN,
4937 	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_AS,
4938 
4939 	/* keep last */
4940 	__NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4941 	NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4942 };
4943 
4944 /**
4945  * enum nl80211_mesh_setup_params - mesh setup parameters
4946  *
4947  * Mesh setup parameters.  These are used to start/join a mesh and cannot be
4948  * changed while the mesh is active.
4949  *
4950  * @__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_INVALID: Internal use
4951  *
4952  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_PATH_SEL: Enable this option to use a
4953  *	vendor specific path selection algorithm or disable it to use the
4954  *	default HWMP.
4955  *
4956  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_METRIC: Enable this option to use a
4957  *	vendor specific path metric or disable it to use the default Airtime
4958  *	metric.
4959  *
4960  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE: Information elements for this mesh, for instance, a
4961  *	robust security network ie, or a vendor specific information element
4962  *	that vendors will use to identify the path selection methods and
4963  *	metrics in use.
4964  *
4965  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH: Enable this option if an authentication
4966  *	daemon will be authenticating mesh candidates.
4967  *
4968  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE: Enable this option if an authentication
4969  *	daemon will be securing peer link frames.  AMPE is a secured version of
4970  *	Mesh Peering Management (MPM) and is implemented with the assistance of
4971  *	a userspace daemon.  When this flag is set, the kernel will send peer
4972  *	management frames to a userspace daemon that will implement AMPE
4973  *	functionality (security capabilities selection, key confirmation, and
4974  *	key management).  When the flag is unset (default), the kernel can
4975  *	autonomously complete (unsecured) mesh peering without the need of a
4976  *	userspace daemon.
4977  *
4978  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_SYNC: Enable this option to use a
4979  *	vendor specific synchronization method or disable it to use the default
4980  *	neighbor offset synchronization
4981  *
4982  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM: Enable this option if userspace will
4983  *	implement an MPM which handles peer allocation and state.
4984  *
4985  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_AUTH_PROTOCOL: Inform the kernel of the authentication
4986  *	method (u8, as defined in IEEE 8.4.2.100.6, e.g. 0x1 for SAE).
4987  *	Default is no authentication method required.
4988  *
4989  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_MAX: highest possible mesh setup attribute number
4990  *
4991  * @__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal use
4992  */
4993 enum nl80211_mesh_setup_params {
4994 	__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_INVALID,
4995 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_PATH_SEL,
4996 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_METRIC,
4997 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE,
4998 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH,
4999 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE,
5000 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_SYNC,
5001 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM,
5002 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_AUTH_PROTOCOL,
5003 
5004 	/* keep last */
5005 	__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
5006 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
5007 };
5008 
5009 /**
5010  * enum nl80211_txq_attr - TX queue parameter attributes
5011  * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_INVALID: Attribute number 0 is reserved
5012  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC: AC identifier (NL80211_AC_*)
5013  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_TXOP: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning
5014  *	disabled
5015  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMIN: Minimum contention window [a value of the form
5016  *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
5017  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMAX: Maximum contention window [a value of the form
5018  *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
5019  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AIFS: Arbitration interframe space [0..255]
5020  * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal
5021  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_MAX: Maximum TXQ attribute number
5022  */
5023 enum nl80211_txq_attr {
5024 	__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_INVALID,
5025 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC,
5026 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_TXOP,
5027 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMIN,
5028 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMAX,
5029 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AIFS,
5030 
5031 	/* keep last */
5032 	__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
5033 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
5034 };
5035 
5036 enum nl80211_ac {
5037 	NL80211_AC_VO,
5038 	NL80211_AC_VI,
5039 	NL80211_AC_BE,
5040 	NL80211_AC_BK,
5041 	NL80211_NUM_ACS
5042 };
5043 
5044 /* backward compat */
5045 #define NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_QUEUE	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC
5046 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_VO	NL80211_AC_VO
5047 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_VI	NL80211_AC_VI
5048 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_BE	NL80211_AC_BE
5049 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_BK	NL80211_AC_BK
5050 
5051 /**
5052  * enum nl80211_channel_type - channel type
5053  * @NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT: 20 MHz, non-HT channel
5054  * @NL80211_CHAN_HT20: 20 MHz HT channel
5055  * @NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS: HT40 channel, secondary channel
5056  *	below the control channel
5057  * @NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS: HT40 channel, secondary channel
5058  *	above the control channel
5059  */
5060 enum nl80211_channel_type {
5061 	NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT,
5062 	NL80211_CHAN_HT20,
5063 	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS,
5064 	NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS
5065 };
5066 
5067 /**
5068  * enum nl80211_key_mode - Key mode
5069  *
5070  * @NL80211_KEY_RX_TX: (Default)
5071  *	Key can be used for Rx and Tx immediately
5072  *
5073  * The following modes can only be selected for unicast keys and when the
5074  * driver supports @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID:
5075  *
5076  * @NL80211_KEY_NO_TX: Only allowed in combination with @NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY:
5077  *	Unicast key can only be used for Rx, Tx not allowed, yet
5078  * @NL80211_KEY_SET_TX: Only allowed in combination with @NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY:
5079  *	The unicast key identified by idx and mac is cleared for Tx and becomes
5080  *	the preferred Tx key for the station.
5081  */
5082 enum nl80211_key_mode {
5083 	NL80211_KEY_RX_TX,
5084 	NL80211_KEY_NO_TX,
5085 	NL80211_KEY_SET_TX
5086 };
5087 
5088 /**
5089  * enum nl80211_chan_width - channel width definitions
5090  *
5091  * These values are used with the %NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH
5092  * attribute.
5093  *
5094  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT: 20 MHz, non-HT channel
5095  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20: 20 MHz HT channel
5096  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40: 40 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
5097  *	attribute must be provided as well
5098  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80: 80 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
5099  *	attribute must be provided as well
5100  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80: 80+80 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
5101  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2 attributes must be provided as well
5102  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160: 160 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
5103  *	attribute must be provided as well
5104  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 5 MHz OFDM channel
5105  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 10 MHz OFDM channel
5106  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_1: 1 MHz OFDM channel
5107  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_2: 2 MHz OFDM channel
5108  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_4: 4 MHz OFDM channel
5109  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_8: 8 MHz OFDM channel
5110  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_16: 16 MHz OFDM channel
5111  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_320: 320 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
5112  *	attribute must be provided as well
5113  */
5114 enum nl80211_chan_width {
5115 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT,
5116 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
5117 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40,
5118 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80,
5119 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80,
5120 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160,
5121 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5,
5122 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10,
5123 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_1,
5124 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_2,
5125 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_4,
5126 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_8,
5127 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_16,
5128 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_320,
5129 };
5130 
5131 /**
5132  * enum nl80211_bss_scan_width - control channel width for a BSS
5133  *
5134  * These values are used with the %NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH attribute.
5135  *
5136  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20: control channel is 20 MHz wide or compatible
5137  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10: control channel is 10 MHz wide
5138  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5: control channel is 5 MHz wide
5139  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_1: control channel is 1 MHz wide
5140  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_2: control channel is 2 MHz wide
5141  */
5142 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width {
5143 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
5144 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10,
5145 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5,
5146 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_1,
5147 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_2,
5148 };
5149 
5150 /**
5151  * enum nl80211_bss_use_for - bitmap indicating possible BSS use
5152  * @NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL: Use this BSS for normal "connection",
5153  *	including IBSS/MBSS depending on the type.
5154  * @NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_MLD_LINK: This BSS can be used as a link in an
5155  *	MLO connection. Note that for an MLO connection, all links including
5156  *	the assoc link must have this flag set, and the assoc link must
5157  *	additionally have %NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL set.
5158  */
5159 enum nl80211_bss_use_for {
5160 	NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL = 1 << 0,
5161 	NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_MLD_LINK = 1 << 1,
5162 };
5163 
5164 /**
5165  * enum nl80211_bss_cannot_use_reasons - reason(s) connection to a
5166  *	BSS isn't possible
5167  * @NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_NSTR_NONPRIMARY: NSTR nonprimary links aren't
5168  *	supported by the device, and this BSS entry represents one.
5169  * @NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_6GHZ_PWR_MISMATCH: STA is not supporting
5170  *	the AP power type (SP, VLP, AP) that the AP uses.
5171  */
5172 enum nl80211_bss_cannot_use_reasons {
5173 	NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_NSTR_NONPRIMARY	= 1 << 0,
5174 	NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_6GHZ_PWR_MISMATCH	= 1 << 1,
5175 };
5176 
5177 #define NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_UHB_PWR_MISMATCH \
5178 	NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_6GHZ_PWR_MISMATCH
5179 
5180 /**
5181  * enum nl80211_bss - netlink attributes for a BSS
5182  *
5183  * @__NL80211_BSS_INVALID: invalid
5184  * @NL80211_BSS_BSSID: BSSID of the BSS (6 octets)
5185  * @NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY: frequency in MHz (u32)
5186  * @NL80211_BSS_TSF: TSF of the received probe response/beacon (u64)
5187  *	(if @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA is present then this is known to be
5188  *	from a probe response, otherwise it may be from the same beacon
5189  *	that the NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF will be from)
5190  * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_INTERVAL: beacon interval of the (I)BSS (u16)
5191  * @NL80211_BSS_CAPABILITY: capability field (CPU order, u16)
5192  * @NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS: binary attribute containing the
5193  *	raw information elements from the probe response/beacon (bin);
5194  *	if the %NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES attribute is present and the data is
5195  *	different then the IEs here are from a Probe Response frame; otherwise
5196  *	they are from a Beacon frame.
5197  *	However, if the driver does not indicate the source of the IEs, these
5198  *	IEs may be from either frame subtype.
5199  *	If present, the @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA attribute indicates that the
5200  *	data here is known to be from a probe response, without any heuristics.
5201  * @NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_MBM: signal strength of probe response/beacon
5202  *	in mBm (100 * dBm) (s32)
5203  * @NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_UNSPEC: signal strength of the probe response/beacon
5204  *	in unspecified units, scaled to 0..100 (u8)
5205  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS: status, if this BSS is "used"
5206  * @NL80211_BSS_SEEN_MS_AGO: age of this BSS entry in ms
5207  * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES: binary attribute containing the raw information
5208  *	elements from a Beacon frame (bin); not present if no Beacon frame has
5209  *	yet been received
5210  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH: channel width of the control channel
5211  *	(u32, enum nl80211_bss_scan_width) - No longer used!
5212  * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF: TSF of the last received beacon (u64)
5213  *	(not present if no beacon frame has been received yet)
5214  * @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA: the data in @NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS and
5215  *	@NL80211_BSS_TSF is known to be from a probe response (flag attribute)
5216  * @NL80211_BSS_LAST_SEEN_BOOTTIME: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp when this entry
5217  *	was last updated by a received frame. The value is expected to be
5218  *	accurate to about 10ms. (u64, nanoseconds)
5219  * @NL80211_BSS_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
5220  * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF: the time at the start of reception of the first
5221  *	octet of the timestamp field of the last beacon/probe received for
5222  *	this BSS. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified by
5223  *	@NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID. (u64).
5224  * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID: the BSS according to which @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF
5225  *	is set.
5226  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAIN_SIGNAL: per-chain signal strength of last BSS update.
5227  *	Contains a nested array of signal strength attributes (u8, dBm),
5228  *	using the nesting index as the antenna number.
5229  * @NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY_OFFSET: frequency offset in KHz
5230  * @NL80211_BSS_MLO_LINK_ID: MLO link ID of the BSS (u8).
5231  * @NL80211_BSS_MLD_ADDR: MLD address of this BSS if connected to it.
5232  * @NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR: u32 bitmap attribute indicating what the BSS can be
5233  *	used for, see &enum nl80211_bss_use_for.
5234  * @NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_REASONS: Indicates the reason that this BSS cannot
5235  *	be used for all or some of the possible uses by the device reporting it,
5236  *	even though its presence was detected.
5237  *	This is a u64 attribute containing a bitmap of values from
5238  *	&enum nl80211_cannot_use_reasons, note that the attribute may be missing
5239  *	if no reasons are specified.
5240  * @__NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST: internal
5241  * @NL80211_BSS_MAX: highest BSS attribute
5242  */
5243 enum nl80211_bss {
5244 	__NL80211_BSS_INVALID,
5245 	NL80211_BSS_BSSID,
5246 	NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY,
5247 	NL80211_BSS_TSF,
5248 	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_INTERVAL,
5249 	NL80211_BSS_CAPABILITY,
5250 	NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS,
5251 	NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_MBM,
5252 	NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
5253 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS,
5254 	NL80211_BSS_SEEN_MS_AGO,
5255 	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES,
5256 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH,
5257 	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF,
5258 	NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA,
5259 	NL80211_BSS_LAST_SEEN_BOOTTIME,
5260 	NL80211_BSS_PAD,
5261 	NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF,
5262 	NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID,
5263 	NL80211_BSS_CHAIN_SIGNAL,
5264 	NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY_OFFSET,
5265 	NL80211_BSS_MLO_LINK_ID,
5266 	NL80211_BSS_MLD_ADDR,
5267 	NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR,
5268 	NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_REASONS,
5269 
5270 	/* keep last */
5271 	__NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST,
5272 	NL80211_BSS_MAX = __NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST - 1
5273 };
5274 
5275 /**
5276  * enum nl80211_bss_status - BSS "status"
5277  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_AUTHENTICATED: Authenticated with this BSS.
5278  *	Note that this is no longer used since cfg80211 no longer
5279  *	keeps track of whether or not authentication was done with
5280  *	a given BSS.
5281  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_ASSOCIATED: Associated with this BSS.
5282  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_IBSS_JOINED: Joined to this IBSS.
5283  *
5284  * The BSS status is a BSS attribute in scan dumps, which
5285  * indicates the status the interface has wrt. this BSS.
5286  */
5287 enum nl80211_bss_status {
5288 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_AUTHENTICATED,
5289 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_ASSOCIATED,
5290 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_IBSS_JOINED,
5291 };
5292 
5293 /**
5294  * enum nl80211_auth_type - AuthenticationType
5295  *
5296  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_OPEN_SYSTEM: Open System authentication
5297  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SHARED_KEY: Shared Key authentication (WEP only)
5298  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FT: Fast BSS Transition (IEEE 802.11r)
5299  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NETWORK_EAP: Network EAP (some Cisco APs and mainly LEAP)
5300  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SAE: Simultaneous authentication of equals
5301  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK: Fast Initial Link Setup shared key
5302  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK_PFS: Fast Initial Link Setup shared key with PFS
5303  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_PK: Fast Initial Link Setup public key
5304  * @__NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM: internal
5305  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_MAX: maximum valid auth algorithm
5306  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_AUTOMATIC: determine automatically (if necessary by
5307  *	trying multiple times); this is invalid in netlink -- leave out
5308  *	the attribute for this on CONNECT commands.
5309  */
5310 enum nl80211_auth_type {
5311 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_OPEN_SYSTEM,
5312 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SHARED_KEY,
5313 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FT,
5314 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NETWORK_EAP,
5315 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SAE,
5316 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK,
5317 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK_PFS,
5318 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_PK,
5319 
5320 	/* keep last */
5321 	__NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM,
5322 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_MAX = __NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM - 1,
5323 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_AUTOMATIC
5324 };
5325 
5326 /**
5327  * enum nl80211_key_type - Key Type
5328  * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_GROUP: Group (broadcast/multicast) key
5329  * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_PAIRWISE: Pairwise (unicast/individual) key
5330  * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_PEERKEY: PeerKey (DLS)
5331  * @NUM_NL80211_KEYTYPES: number of defined key types
5332  */
5333 enum nl80211_key_type {
5334 	NL80211_KEYTYPE_GROUP,
5335 	NL80211_KEYTYPE_PAIRWISE,
5336 	NL80211_KEYTYPE_PEERKEY,
5337 
5338 	NUM_NL80211_KEYTYPES
5339 };
5340 
5341 /**
5342  * enum nl80211_mfp - Management frame protection state
5343  * @NL80211_MFP_NO: Management frame protection not used
5344  * @NL80211_MFP_REQUIRED: Management frame protection required
5345  * @NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL: Management frame protection is optional
5346  */
5347 enum nl80211_mfp {
5348 	NL80211_MFP_NO,
5349 	NL80211_MFP_REQUIRED,
5350 	NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL,
5351 };
5352 
5353 enum nl80211_wpa_versions {
5354 	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_1 = 1 << 0,
5355 	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_2 = 1 << 1,
5356 	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_3 = 1 << 2,
5357 };
5358 
5359 /**
5360  * enum nl80211_key_default_types - key default types
5361  * @__NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_INVALID: invalid
5362  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_UNICAST: key should be used as default
5363  *	unicast key
5364  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_MULTICAST: key should be used as default
5365  *	multicast key
5366  * @NUM_NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: number of default types
5367  */
5368 enum nl80211_key_default_types {
5369 	__NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_INVALID,
5370 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_UNICAST,
5371 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_MULTICAST,
5372 
5373 	NUM_NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES
5374 };
5375 
5376 /**
5377  * enum nl80211_key_attributes - key attributes
5378  * @__NL80211_KEY_INVALID: invalid
5379  * @NL80211_KEY_DATA: (temporal) key data; for TKIP this consists of
5380  *	16 bytes encryption key followed by 8 bytes each for TX and RX MIC
5381  *	keys
5382  * @NL80211_KEY_IDX: key ID (u8, 0-3)
5383  * @NL80211_KEY_CIPHER: key cipher suite (u32, as defined by IEEE 802.11
5384  *	section 7.3.2.25.1, e.g. 0x000FAC04)
5385  * @NL80211_KEY_SEQ: transmit key sequence number (IV/PN) for TKIP and
5386  *	CCMP keys, each six bytes in little endian
5387  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT: flag indicating default key
5388  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT: flag indicating default management key
5389  * @NL80211_KEY_TYPE: the key type from enum nl80211_key_type, if not
5390  *	specified the default depends on whether a MAC address was
5391  *	given with the command using the key or not (u32)
5392  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: A nested attribute containing flags
5393  *	attributes, specifying what a key should be set as default as.
5394  *	See &enum nl80211_key_default_types.
5395  * @NL80211_KEY_MODE: the mode from enum nl80211_key_mode.
5396  *	Defaults to @NL80211_KEY_RX_TX.
5397  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_BEACON: flag indicating default Beacon frame key
5398  *
5399  * @__NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST: internal
5400  * @NL80211_KEY_MAX: highest key attribute
5401  */
5402 enum nl80211_key_attributes {
5403 	__NL80211_KEY_INVALID,
5404 	NL80211_KEY_DATA,
5405 	NL80211_KEY_IDX,
5406 	NL80211_KEY_CIPHER,
5407 	NL80211_KEY_SEQ,
5408 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT,
5409 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT,
5410 	NL80211_KEY_TYPE,
5411 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES,
5412 	NL80211_KEY_MODE,
5413 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_BEACON,
5414 
5415 	/* keep last */
5416 	__NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST,
5417 	NL80211_KEY_MAX = __NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST - 1
5418 };
5419 
5420 /**
5421  * enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes - TX rate set attributes
5422  * @__NL80211_TXRATE_INVALID: invalid
5423  * @NL80211_TXRATE_LEGACY: Legacy (non-MCS) rates allowed for TX rate selection
5424  *	in an array of rates as defined in IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 (u8 values with
5425  *	1 = 500 kbps) but without the IE length restriction (at most
5426  *	%NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES in a single array).
5427  * @NL80211_TXRATE_HT: HT (MCS) rates allowed for TX rate selection
5428  *	in an array of MCS numbers.
5429  * @NL80211_TXRATE_VHT: VHT rates allowed for TX rate selection,
5430  *	see &struct nl80211_txrate_vht
5431  * @NL80211_TXRATE_GI: configure GI, see &enum nl80211_txrate_gi
5432  * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE: HE rates allowed for TX rate selection,
5433  *	see &struct nl80211_txrate_he
5434  * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE_GI: configure HE GI, 0.8us, 1.6us and 3.2us.
5435  * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE_LTF: configure HE LTF, 1XLTF, 2XLTF and 4XLTF.
5436  * @__NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST: internal
5437  * @NL80211_TXRATE_MAX: highest TX rate attribute
5438  */
5439 enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes {
5440 	__NL80211_TXRATE_INVALID,
5441 	NL80211_TXRATE_LEGACY,
5442 	NL80211_TXRATE_HT,
5443 	NL80211_TXRATE_VHT,
5444 	NL80211_TXRATE_GI,
5445 	NL80211_TXRATE_HE,
5446 	NL80211_TXRATE_HE_GI,
5447 	NL80211_TXRATE_HE_LTF,
5448 
5449 	/* keep last */
5450 	__NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST,
5451 	NL80211_TXRATE_MAX = __NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST - 1
5452 };
5453 
5454 #define NL80211_TXRATE_MCS NL80211_TXRATE_HT
5455 #define NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX		8
5456 
5457 /**
5458  * struct nl80211_txrate_vht - VHT MCS/NSS txrate bitmap
5459  * @mcs: MCS bitmap table for each NSS (array index 0 for 1 stream, etc.)
5460  */
5461 struct nl80211_txrate_vht {
5462 	__u16 mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX];
5463 };
5464 
5465 #define NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX		8
5466 /**
5467  * struct nl80211_txrate_he - HE MCS/NSS txrate bitmap
5468  * @mcs: MCS bitmap table for each NSS (array index 0 for 1 stream, etc.)
5469  */
5470 struct nl80211_txrate_he {
5471 	__u16 mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX];
5472 };
5473 
5474 enum nl80211_txrate_gi {
5475 	NL80211_TXRATE_DEFAULT_GI,
5476 	NL80211_TXRATE_FORCE_SGI,
5477 	NL80211_TXRATE_FORCE_LGI,
5478 };
5479 
5480 /**
5481  * enum nl80211_band - Frequency band
5482  * @NL80211_BAND_2GHZ: 2.4 GHz ISM band
5483  * @NL80211_BAND_5GHZ: around 5 GHz band (4.9 - 5.7 GHz)
5484  * @NL80211_BAND_60GHZ: around 60 GHz band (58.32 - 69.12 GHz)
5485  * @NL80211_BAND_6GHZ: around 6 GHz band (5.9 - 7.2 GHz)
5486  * @NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ: around 900MHz, supported by S1G PHYs
5487  * @NL80211_BAND_LC: light communication band (placeholder)
5488  * @NUM_NL80211_BANDS: number of bands, avoid using this in userspace
5489  *	since newer kernel versions may support more bands
5490  */
5491 enum nl80211_band {
5492 	NL80211_BAND_2GHZ,
5493 	NL80211_BAND_5GHZ,
5494 	NL80211_BAND_60GHZ,
5495 	NL80211_BAND_6GHZ,
5496 	NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ,
5497 	NL80211_BAND_LC,
5498 
5499 	NUM_NL80211_BANDS,
5500 };
5501 
5502 /**
5503  * enum nl80211_ps_state - powersave state
5504  * @NL80211_PS_DISABLED: powersave is disabled
5505  * @NL80211_PS_ENABLED: powersave is enabled
5506  */
5507 enum nl80211_ps_state {
5508 	NL80211_PS_DISABLED,
5509 	NL80211_PS_ENABLED,
5510 };
5511 
5512 /**
5513  * enum nl80211_attr_cqm - connection quality monitor attributes
5514  * @__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_INVALID: invalid
5515  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD: RSSI threshold in dBm. This value specifies
5516  *	the threshold for the RSSI level at which an event will be sent. Zero
5517  *	to disable.  Alternatively, if %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST is
5518  *	set, multiple values can be supplied as a low-to-high sorted array of
5519  *	threshold values in dBm.  Events will be sent when the RSSI value
5520  *	crosses any of the thresholds.
5521  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_HYST: RSSI hysteresis in dBm. This value specifies
5522  *	the minimum amount the RSSI level must change after an event before a
5523  *	new event may be issued (to reduce effects of RSSI oscillation).
5524  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT: RSSI threshold event
5525  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_PKT_LOSS_EVENT: a u32 value indicating that this many
5526  *	consecutive packets were not acknowledged by the peer
5527  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE: TX error rate in %. Minimum % of TX failures
5528  *	during the given %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL before an
5529  *	%NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM with reported %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE and
5530  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS is generated.
5531  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS: number of attempted packets in a given
5532  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL before %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE is
5533  *	checked.
5534  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL: interval in seconds. Specifies the periodic
5535  *	interval in which %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS and
5536  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE must be satisfied before generating an
5537  *	%NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM. Set to 0 to turn off TX error reporting.
5538  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT: flag attribute that's set in a beacon
5539  *	loss event
5540  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_LEVEL: the RSSI value in dBm that triggered the
5541  *	RSSI threshold event.
5542  * @__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST: internal
5543  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_MAX: highest key attribute
5544  */
5545 enum nl80211_attr_cqm {
5546 	__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_INVALID,
5547 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD,
5548 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_HYST,
5549 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT,
5550 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_PKT_LOSS_EVENT,
5551 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE,
5552 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS,
5553 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL,
5554 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT,
5555 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_LEVEL,
5556 
5557 	/* keep last */
5558 	__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST,
5559 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_MAX = __NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST - 1
5560 };
5561 
5562 /**
5563  * enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event - RSSI threshold event
5564  * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_LOW: The RSSI level is lower than the
5565  *      configured threshold
5566  * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_HIGH: The RSSI is higher than the
5567  *      configured threshold
5568  * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT: (reserved, never sent)
5569  */
5570 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event {
5571 	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_LOW,
5572 	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_HIGH,
5573 	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT,
5574 };
5575 
5576 
5577 /**
5578  * enum nl80211_tx_power_setting - TX power adjustment
5579  * @NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC: automatically determine transmit power
5580  * @NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED: limit TX power by the mBm parameter
5581  * @NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED: fix TX power to the mBm parameter
5582  */
5583 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting {
5584 	NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC,
5585 	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED,
5586 	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED,
5587 };
5588 
5589 /**
5590  * enum nl80211_tid_config - TID config state
5591  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ENABLE: Enable config for the TID
5592  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_DISABLE: Disable config for the TID
5593  */
5594 enum nl80211_tid_config {
5595 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ENABLE,
5596 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_DISABLE,
5597 };
5598 
5599 /* enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting - TX rate configuration type
5600  * @NL80211_TX_RATE_AUTOMATIC: automatically determine TX rate
5601  * @NL80211_TX_RATE_LIMITED: limit the TX rate by the TX rate parameter
5602  * @NL80211_TX_RATE_FIXED: fix TX rate to the TX rate parameter
5603  */
5604 enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting {
5605 	NL80211_TX_RATE_AUTOMATIC,
5606 	NL80211_TX_RATE_LIMITED,
5607 	NL80211_TX_RATE_FIXED,
5608 };
5609 
5610 /* enum nl80211_tid_config_attr - TID specific configuration.
5611  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PAD: pad attribute for 64-bit values
5612  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_VIF_SUPP: a bitmap (u64) of attributes supported
5613  *	for per-vif configuration; doesn't list the ones that are generic
5614  *	(%NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS, %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE).
5615  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PEER_SUPP: same as the previous per-vif one, but
5616  *	per peer instead.
5617  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE: flag attribute, if set indicates
5618  *	that the new configuration overrides all previous peer
5619  *	configurations, otherwise previous peer specific configurations
5620  *	should be left untouched.
5621  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS: a bitmask value of TIDs (bit 0 to 7)
5622  *	Its type is u16.
5623  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_NOACK: Configure ack policy for the TID.
5624  *	specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TID. see %enum nl80211_tid_config.
5625  *	Its type is u8.
5626  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT: Number of retries used with data frame
5627  *	transmission, user-space sets this configuration in
5628  *	&NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG. It is u8 type, min value is 1 and
5629  *	the max value is advertised by the driver in this attribute on
5630  *	output in wiphy capabilities.
5631  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG: Number of retries used with data frame
5632  *	transmission, user-space sets this configuration in
5633  *	&NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG. Its type is u8, min value is 1 and
5634  *	the max value is advertised by the driver in this attribute on
5635  *	output in wiphy capabilities.
5636  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMPDU_CTRL: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation
5637  *	for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS.
5638  *	Its type is u8, using the values from &nl80211_tid_config.
5639  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RTSCTS_CTRL: Enable/Disable RTS_CTS for the TIDs
5640  *	specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. It is u8 type, using
5641  *	the values from &nl80211_tid_config.
5642  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMSDU_CTRL: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation
5643  *	for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS.
5644  *	Its type is u8, using the values from &nl80211_tid_config.
5645  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE_TYPE: This attribute will be useful
5646  *	to notfiy the driver that what type of txrate should be used
5647  *	for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. using
5648  *	the values form &nl80211_tx_rate_setting.
5649  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE: Data frame TX rate mask should be applied
5650  *	with the parameters passed through %NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES.
5651  *	configuration is applied to the data frame for the tid to that connected
5652  *	station.
5653  */
5654 enum nl80211_tid_config_attr {
5655 	__NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID,
5656 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PAD,
5657 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_VIF_SUPP,
5658 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PEER_SUPP,
5659 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE,
5660 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS,
5661 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_NOACK,
5662 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT,
5663 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG,
5664 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMPDU_CTRL,
5665 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RTSCTS_CTRL,
5666 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMSDU_CTRL,
5667 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE_TYPE,
5668 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE,
5669 
5670 	/* keep last */
5671 	__NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
5672 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
5673 };
5674 
5675 /**
5676  * enum nl80211_packet_pattern_attr - packet pattern attribute
5677  * @__NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
5678  * @NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN: the pattern, values where the mask has
5679  *	a zero bit are ignored
5680  * @NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK: pattern mask, must be long enough to have
5681  *	a bit for each byte in the pattern. The lowest-order bit corresponds
5682  *	to the first byte of the pattern, but the bytes of the pattern are
5683  *	in a little-endian-like format, i.e. the 9th byte of the pattern
5684  *	corresponds to the lowest-order bit in the second byte of the mask.
5685  *	For example: The match 00:xx:00:00:xx:00:00:00:00:xx:xx:xx (where
5686  *	xx indicates "don't care") would be represented by a pattern of
5687  *	twelve zero bytes, and a mask of "0xed,0x01".
5688  *	Note that the pattern matching is done as though frames were not
5689  *	802.11 frames but 802.3 frames, i.e. the frame is fully unpacked
5690  *	first (including SNAP header unpacking) and then matched.
5691  * @NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET: packet offset, pattern is matched after
5692  *	these fixed number of bytes of received packet
5693  * @NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT: number of attributes
5694  * @MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT: max attribute number
5695  */
5696 enum nl80211_packet_pattern_attr {
5697 	__NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID,
5698 	NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK,
5699 	NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN,
5700 	NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET,
5701 
5702 	NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT,
5703 	MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT = NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT - 1,
5704 };
5705 
5706 /**
5707  * struct nl80211_pattern_support - packet pattern support information
5708  * @max_patterns: maximum number of patterns supported
5709  * @min_pattern_len: minimum length of each pattern
5710  * @max_pattern_len: maximum length of each pattern
5711  * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
5712  *
5713  * This struct is carried in %NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN when
5714  * that is part of %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED or in
5715  * %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN when that is part of
5716  * %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE in the capability information given
5717  * by the kernel to userspace.
5718  */
5719 struct nl80211_pattern_support {
5720 	__u32 max_patterns;
5721 	__u32 min_pattern_len;
5722 	__u32 max_pattern_len;
5723 	__u32 max_pkt_offset;
5724 } __attribute__((packed));
5725 
5726 /* only for backward compatibility */
5727 #define __NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_INVALID __NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID
5728 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_MASK NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK
5729 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_PATTERN NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN
5730 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_OFFSET NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET
5731 #define NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT
5732 #define MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT
5733 #define nl80211_wowlan_pattern_support nl80211_pattern_support
5734 
5735 /**
5736  * enum nl80211_wowlan_triggers - WoWLAN trigger definitions
5737  * @__NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
5738  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_ANY: wake up on any activity, do not really put
5739  *	the chip into a special state -- works best with chips that have
5740  *	support for low-power operation already (flag)
5741  *	Note that this mode is incompatible with all of the others, if
5742  *	any others are even supported by the device.
5743  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_DISCONNECT: wake up on disconnect, the way disconnect
5744  *	is detected is implementation-specific (flag)
5745  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_MAGIC_PKT: wake up on magic packet (6x 0xff, followed
5746  *	by 16 repetitions of MAC addr, anywhere in payload) (flag)
5747  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN: wake up on the specified packet patterns
5748  *	which are passed in an array of nested attributes, each nested attribute
5749  *	defining a with attributes from &struct nl80211_wowlan_trig_pkt_pattern.
5750  *	Each pattern defines a wakeup packet. Packet offset is associated with
5751  *	each pattern which is used while matching the pattern. The matching is
5752  *	done on the MSDU, i.e. as though the packet was an 802.3 packet, so the
5753  *	pattern matching is done after the packet is converted to the MSDU.
5754  *
5755  *	In %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED, it is a binary attribute
5756  *	carrying a &struct nl80211_pattern_support.
5757  *
5758  *	When reporting wakeup. it is a u32 attribute containing the 0-based
5759  *	index of the pattern that caused the wakeup, in the patterns passed
5760  *	to the kernel when configuring.
5761  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_SUPPORTED: Not a real trigger, and cannot be
5762  *	used when setting, used only to indicate that GTK rekeying is supported
5763  *	by the device (flag)
5764  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: wake up on GTK rekey failure (if
5765  *	done by the device) (flag)
5766  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_EAP_IDENT_REQUEST: wake up on EAP Identity Request
5767  *	packet (flag)
5768  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: wake up on 4-way handshake (flag)
5769  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_RFKILL_RELEASE: wake up when rfkill is released
5770  *	(on devices that have rfkill in the device) (flag)
5771  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211: For wakeup reporting only, contains
5772  *	the 802.11 packet that caused the wakeup, e.g. a deauth frame. The frame
5773  *	may be truncated, the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN
5774  *	attribute contains the original length.
5775  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN: Original length of the 802.11
5776  *	packet, may be bigger than the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211
5777  *	attribute if the packet was truncated somewhere.
5778  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023: For wakeup reporting only, contains the
5779  *	802.11 packet that caused the wakeup, e.g. a magic packet. The frame may
5780  *	be truncated, the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN attribute
5781  *	contains the original length.
5782  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN: Original length of the 802.3
5783  *	packet, may be bigger than the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023
5784  *	attribute if the packet was truncated somewhere.
5785  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_CONNECTION: TCP connection wake, see DOC section
5786  *	"TCP connection wakeup" for more details. This is a nested attribute
5787  *	containing the exact information for establishing and keeping alive
5788  *	the TCP connection.
5789  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_MATCH: For wakeup reporting only, the
5790  *	wakeup packet was received on the TCP connection
5791  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_CONNLOST: For wakeup reporting only, the
5792  *	TCP connection was lost or failed to be established
5793  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_NOMORETOKENS: For wakeup reporting only,
5794  *	the TCP connection ran out of tokens to use for data to send to the
5795  *	service
5796  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT: wake up when a configured network
5797  *	is detected.  This is a nested attribute that contains the
5798  *	same attributes used with @NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN.  It
5799  *	specifies how the scan is performed (e.g. the interval, the
5800  *	channels to scan and the initial delay) as well as the scan
5801  *	results that will trigger a wake (i.e. the matchsets).  This
5802  *	attribute is also sent in a response to
5803  *	@NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY, indicating the number of match sets
5804  *	supported by the driver (u32).
5805  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT_RESULTS: nested attribute
5806  *	containing an array with information about what triggered the
5807  *	wake up.  If no elements are present in the array, it means
5808  *	that the information is not available.  If more than one
5809  *	element is present, it means that more than one match
5810  *	occurred.
5811  *	Each element in the array is a nested attribute that contains
5812  *	one optional %NL80211_ATTR_SSID attribute and one optional
5813  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES attribute.  At least one of
5814  *	these attributes must be present.  If
5815  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES contains more than one
5816  *	frequency, it means that the match occurred in more than one
5817  *	channel.
5818  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_UNPROTECTED_DEAUTH_DISASSOC: For wakeup reporting only.
5819  *	Wake up happened due to unprotected deauth or disassoc frame in MFP.
5820  * @NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG: number of wake on wireless triggers
5821  * @MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG: highest wowlan trigger attribute number
5822  *
5823  * These nested attributes are used to configure the wakeup triggers and
5824  * to report the wakeup reason(s).
5825  */
5826 enum nl80211_wowlan_triggers {
5827 	__NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_INVALID,
5828 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_ANY,
5829 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_DISCONNECT,
5830 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_MAGIC_PKT,
5831 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN,
5832 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_SUPPORTED,
5833 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE,
5834 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_EAP_IDENT_REQUEST,
5835 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_4WAY_HANDSHAKE,
5836 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_RFKILL_RELEASE,
5837 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211,
5838 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN,
5839 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023,
5840 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN,
5841 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_CONNECTION,
5842 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_MATCH,
5843 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_CONNLOST,
5844 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_NOMORETOKENS,
5845 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT,
5846 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT_RESULTS,
5847 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_UNPROTECTED_DEAUTH_DISASSOC,
5848 
5849 	/* keep last */
5850 	NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG,
5851 	MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG = NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG - 1
5852 };
5853 
5854 /**
5855  * DOC: TCP connection wakeup
5856  *
5857  * Some devices can establish a TCP connection in order to be woken up by a
5858  * packet coming in from outside their network segment, or behind NAT. If
5859  * configured, the device will establish a TCP connection to the given
5860  * service, and periodically send data to that service. The first data
5861  * packet is usually transmitted after SYN/ACK, also ACKing the SYN/ACK.
5862  * The data packets can optionally include a (little endian) sequence
5863  * number (in the TCP payload!) that is generated by the device, and, also
5864  * optionally, a token from a list of tokens. This serves as a keep-alive
5865  * with the service, and for NATed connections, etc.
5866  *
5867  * During this keep-alive period, the server doesn't send any data to the
5868  * client. When receiving data, it is compared against the wakeup pattern
5869  * (and mask) and if it matches, the host is woken up. Similarly, if the
5870  * connection breaks or cannot be established to start with, the host is
5871  * also woken up.
5872  *
5873  * Developer's note: ARP offload is required for this, otherwise TCP
5874  * response packets might not go through correctly.
5875  */
5876 
5877 /**
5878  * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq - WoWLAN TCP data sequence
5879  * @start: starting value
5880  * @offset: offset of sequence number in packet
5881  * @len: length of the sequence value to write, 1 through 4
5882  *
5883  * Note: don't confuse with the TCP sequence number(s), this is for the
5884  * keepalive packet payload. The actual value is written into the packet
5885  * in little endian.
5886  */
5887 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq {
5888 	__u32 start, offset, len;
5889 };
5890 
5891 /**
5892  * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token - WoWLAN TCP data token config
5893  * @offset: offset of token in packet
5894  * @len: length of each token
5895  * @token_stream: stream of data to be used for the tokens, the length must
5896  *	be a multiple of @len for this to make sense
5897  */
5898 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token {
5899 	__u32 offset, len;
5900 	__u8 token_stream[];
5901 };
5902 
5903 /**
5904  * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature - data token features
5905  * @min_len: minimum token length
5906  * @max_len: maximum token length
5907  * @bufsize: total available token buffer size (max size of @token_stream)
5908  */
5909 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature {
5910 	__u32 min_len, max_len, bufsize;
5911 };
5912 
5913 /**
5914  * enum nl80211_wowlan_tcp_attrs - WoWLAN TCP connection parameters
5915  * @__NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
5916  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_IPV4: source IPv4 address (in network byte order)
5917  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_IPV4: destination IPv4 address
5918  *	(in network byte order)
5919  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_MAC: destination MAC address, this is given because
5920  *	route lookup when configured might be invalid by the time we suspend,
5921  *	and doing a route lookup when suspending is no longer possible as it
5922  *	might require ARP querying.
5923  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_PORT: source port (u16); optional, if not given a
5924  *	socket and port will be allocated
5925  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_PORT: destination port (u16)
5926  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD: data packet payload, at least one byte.
5927  *	For feature advertising, a u32 attribute holding the maximum length
5928  *	of the data payload.
5929  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_SEQ: data packet sequence configuration
5930  *	(if desired), a &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq. For feature
5931  *	advertising it is just a flag
5932  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_TOKEN: data packet token configuration,
5933  *	see &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token and for advertising see
5934  *	&struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature.
5935  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_INTERVAL: data interval in seconds, maximum
5936  *	interval in feature advertising (u32)
5937  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_PAYLOAD: wake packet payload, for advertising a
5938  *	u32 attribute holding the maximum length
5939  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_MASK: Wake packet payload mask, not used for
5940  *	feature advertising. The mask works like @NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK
5941  *	but on the TCP payload only.
5942  * @NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP: number of TCP attributes
5943  * @MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP: highest attribute number
5944  */
5945 enum nl80211_wowlan_tcp_attrs {
5946 	__NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_INVALID,
5947 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_IPV4,
5948 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_IPV4,
5949 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_MAC,
5950 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_PORT,
5951 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_PORT,
5952 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD,
5953 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_SEQ,
5954 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_TOKEN,
5955 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_INTERVAL,
5956 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_PAYLOAD,
5957 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_MASK,
5958 
5959 	/* keep last */
5960 	NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP,
5961 	MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP = NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP - 1
5962 };
5963 
5964 /**
5965  * struct nl80211_coalesce_rule_support - coalesce rule support information
5966  * @max_rules: maximum number of rules supported
5967  * @pat: packet pattern support information
5968  * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs
5969  *
5970  * This struct is carried in %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE in the
5971  * capability information given by the kernel to userspace.
5972  */
5973 struct nl80211_coalesce_rule_support {
5974 	__u32 max_rules;
5975 	struct nl80211_pattern_support pat;
5976 	__u32 max_delay;
5977 } __attribute__((packed));
5978 
5979 /**
5980  * enum nl80211_attr_coalesce_rule - coalesce rule attribute
5981  * @__NL80211_COALESCE_RULE_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
5982  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_DELAY: delay in msecs used for packet coalescing
5983  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_CONDITION: condition for packet coalescence,
5984  *	see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition.
5985  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN: packet offset, pattern is matched
5986  *	after these fixed number of bytes of received packet
5987  * @NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE: number of attributes
5988  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_MAX: max attribute number
5989  */
5990 enum nl80211_attr_coalesce_rule {
5991 	__NL80211_COALESCE_RULE_INVALID,
5992 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_DELAY,
5993 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_CONDITION,
5994 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN,
5995 
5996 	/* keep last */
5997 	NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE,
5998 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE - 1
5999 };
6000 
6001 /**
6002  * enum nl80211_coalesce_condition - coalesce rule conditions
6003  * @NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_MATCH: coalesce Rx packets when patterns
6004  *	in a rule are matched.
6005  * @NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_NO_MATCH: coalesce Rx packets when patterns
6006  *	in a rule are not matched.
6007  */
6008 enum nl80211_coalesce_condition {
6009 	NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_MATCH,
6010 	NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_NO_MATCH
6011 };
6012 
6013 /**
6014  * enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs - limit attributes
6015  * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_UNSPEC: (reserved)
6016  * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_MAX: maximum number of interfaces that
6017  *	can be chosen from this set of interface types (u32)
6018  * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_TYPES: nested attribute containing a
6019  *	flag attribute for each interface type in this set
6020  * @NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT: number of attributes
6021  * @MAX_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT: highest attribute number
6022  */
6023 enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs {
6024 	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_UNSPEC,
6025 	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_MAX,
6026 	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_TYPES,
6027 
6028 	/* keep last */
6029 	NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT,
6030 	MAX_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT = NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT - 1
6031 };
6032 
6033 /**
6034  * enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs -- interface combination attributes
6035  *
6036  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_UNSPEC: (reserved)
6037  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_LIMITS: Nested attributes containing the limits
6038  *	for given interface types, see &enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs.
6039  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_MAXNUM: u32 attribute giving the total number of
6040  *	interfaces that can be created in this group. This number doesn't
6041  *	apply to interfaces purely managed in software, which are listed
6042  *	in a separate attribute %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACES_SOFTWARE.
6043  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_STA_AP_BI_MATCH: flag attribute specifying that
6044  *	beacon intervals within this group must be all the same even for
6045  *	infrastructure and AP/GO combinations, i.e. the GO(s) must adopt
6046  *	the infrastructure network's beacon interval.
6047  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_NUM_CHANNELS: u32 attribute specifying how many
6048  *	different channels may be used within this group.
6049  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_WIDTHS: u32 attribute containing the bitmap
6050  *	of supported channel widths for radar detection.
6051  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_REGIONS: u32 attribute containing the bitmap
6052  *	of supported regulatory regions for radar detection.
6053  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_BI_MIN_GCD: u32 attribute specifying the minimum GCD of
6054  *	different beacon intervals supported by all the interface combinations
6055  *	in this group (if not present, all beacon intervals be identical).
6056  * @NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB: number of attributes
6057  * @MAX_NL80211_IFACE_COMB: highest attribute number
6058  *
6059  * Examples:
6060  *	limits = [ #{STA} <= 1, #{AP} <= 1 ], matching BI, channels = 1, max = 2
6061  *	=> allows an AP and a STA that must match BIs
6062  *
6063  *	numbers = [ #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8 ], BI min gcd, channels = 1, max = 8,
6064  *	=> allows 8 of AP/GO that can have BI gcd >= min gcd
6065  *
6066  *	numbers = [ #{STA} <= 2 ], channels = 2, max = 2
6067  *	=> allows two STAs on the same or on different channels
6068  *
6069  *	numbers = [ #{STA} <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 ], max = 4
6070  *	=> allows a STA plus three P2P interfaces
6071  *
6072  * The list of these four possibilities could completely be contained
6073  * within the %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS attribute to indicate
6074  * that any of these groups must match.
6075  *
6076  * "Combinations" of just a single interface will not be listed here,
6077  * a single interface of any valid interface type is assumed to always
6078  * be possible by itself. This means that implicitly, for each valid
6079  * interface type, the following group always exists:
6080  *	numbers = [ #{<type>} <= 1 ], channels = 1, max = 1
6081  */
6082 enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs {
6083 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_UNSPEC,
6084 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_LIMITS,
6085 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_MAXNUM,
6086 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_STA_AP_BI_MATCH,
6087 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_NUM_CHANNELS,
6088 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_WIDTHS,
6089 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_REGIONS,
6090 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_BI_MIN_GCD,
6091 
6092 	/* keep last */
6093 	NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB,
6094 	MAX_NL80211_IFACE_COMB = NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB - 1
6095 };
6096 
6097 
6098 /**
6099  * enum nl80211_plink_state - state of a mesh peer link finite state machine
6100  *
6101  * @NL80211_PLINK_LISTEN: initial state, considered the implicit
6102  *	state of non-existent mesh peer links
6103  * @NL80211_PLINK_OPN_SNT: mesh plink open frame has been sent to
6104  *	this mesh peer
6105  * @NL80211_PLINK_OPN_RCVD: mesh plink open frame has been received
6106  *	from this mesh peer
6107  * @NL80211_PLINK_CNF_RCVD: mesh plink confirm frame has been
6108  *	received from this mesh peer
6109  * @NL80211_PLINK_ESTAB: mesh peer link is established
6110  * @NL80211_PLINK_HOLDING: mesh peer link is being closed or cancelled
6111  * @NL80211_PLINK_BLOCKED: all frames transmitted from this mesh
6112  *	plink are discarded, except for authentication frames
6113  * @NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES: number of peer link states
6114  * @MAX_NL80211_PLINK_STATES: highest numerical value of plink states
6115  */
6116 enum nl80211_plink_state {
6117 	NL80211_PLINK_LISTEN,
6118 	NL80211_PLINK_OPN_SNT,
6119 	NL80211_PLINK_OPN_RCVD,
6120 	NL80211_PLINK_CNF_RCVD,
6121 	NL80211_PLINK_ESTAB,
6122 	NL80211_PLINK_HOLDING,
6123 	NL80211_PLINK_BLOCKED,
6124 
6125 	/* keep last */
6126 	NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES,
6127 	MAX_NL80211_PLINK_STATES = NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES - 1
6128 };
6129 
6130 /**
6131  * enum nl80211_plink_action - actions to perform in mesh peers
6132  *
6133  * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_NO_ACTION: perform no action
6134  * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_OPEN: start mesh peer link establishment
6135  * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_BLOCK: block traffic from this mesh peer
6136  * @NUM_NL80211_PLINK_ACTIONS: number of possible actions
6137  */
6138 enum nl80211_plink_action {
6139 	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_NO_ACTION,
6140 	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_OPEN,
6141 	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_BLOCK,
6142 
6143 	NUM_NL80211_PLINK_ACTIONS,
6144 };
6145 
6146 
6147 #define NL80211_KCK_LEN			16
6148 #define NL80211_KEK_LEN			16
6149 #define NL80211_KCK_EXT_LEN		24
6150 #define NL80211_KEK_EXT_LEN		32
6151 #define NL80211_KCK_EXT_LEN_32		32
6152 #define NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN		8
6153 
6154 /**
6155  * enum nl80211_rekey_data - attributes for GTK rekey offload
6156  * @__NL80211_REKEY_DATA_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
6157  * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KEK: key encryption key (binary)
6158  * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KCK: key confirmation key (binary)
6159  * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_REPLAY_CTR: replay counter (binary)
6160  * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_AKM: AKM data (OUI, suite type)
6161  * @NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA: number of rekey attributes (internal)
6162  * @MAX_NL80211_REKEY_DATA: highest rekey attribute (internal)
6163  */
6164 enum nl80211_rekey_data {
6165 	__NL80211_REKEY_DATA_INVALID,
6166 	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KEK,
6167 	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KCK,
6168 	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_REPLAY_CTR,
6169 	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_AKM,
6170 
6171 	/* keep last */
6172 	NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA,
6173 	MAX_NL80211_REKEY_DATA = NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA - 1
6174 };
6175 
6176 /**
6177  * enum nl80211_hidden_ssid - values for %NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID
6178  * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_NOT_IN_USE: do not hide SSID (i.e., broadcast it in
6179  *	Beacon frames)
6180  * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_LEN: hide SSID by using zero-length SSID element
6181  *	in Beacon frames
6182  * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_CONTENTS: hide SSID by using correct length of SSID
6183  *	element in Beacon frames but zero out each byte in the SSID
6184  */
6185 enum nl80211_hidden_ssid {
6186 	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_NOT_IN_USE,
6187 	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_LEN,
6188 	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_CONTENTS
6189 };
6190 
6191 /**
6192  * enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr - station WME attributes
6193  * @__NL80211_STA_WME_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
6194  * @NL80211_STA_WME_UAPSD_QUEUES: bitmap of uapsd queues. the format
6195  *	is the same as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field.
6196  * @NL80211_STA_WME_MAX_SP: max service period. the format is the same
6197  *	as the MAX_SP field in the QoS info field (but already shifted down).
6198  * @__NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST: internal
6199  * @NL80211_STA_WME_MAX: highest station WME attribute
6200  */
6201 enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr {
6202 	__NL80211_STA_WME_INVALID,
6203 	NL80211_STA_WME_UAPSD_QUEUES,
6204 	NL80211_STA_WME_MAX_SP,
6205 
6206 	/* keep last */
6207 	__NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST,
6208 	NL80211_STA_WME_MAX = __NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST - 1
6209 };
6210 
6211 /**
6212  * enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr - attributes for PMKSA caching candidates
6213  * @__NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
6214  * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INDEX: candidate index (u32; the smaller, the higher
6215  *	priority)
6216  * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_BSSID: candidate BSSID (6 octets)
6217  * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_PREAUTH: RSN pre-authentication supported (flag)
6218  * @NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: number of PMKSA caching candidate attributes
6219  *	(internal)
6220  * @MAX_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: highest PMKSA caching candidate attribute
6221  *	(internal)
6222  */
6223 enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr {
6224 	__NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INVALID,
6225 	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INDEX,
6226 	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_BSSID,
6227 	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_PREAUTH,
6228 
6229 	/* keep last */
6230 	NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
6231 	MAX_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE = NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE - 1
6232 };
6233 
6234 /**
6235  * enum nl80211_tdls_operation - values for %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION
6236  * @NL80211_TDLS_DISCOVERY_REQ: Send a TDLS discovery request
6237  * @NL80211_TDLS_SETUP: Setup TDLS link
6238  * @NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN: Teardown a TDLS link which is already established
6239  * @NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK: Enable TDLS link
6240  * @NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK: Disable TDLS link
6241  */
6242 enum nl80211_tdls_operation {
6243 	NL80211_TDLS_DISCOVERY_REQ,
6244 	NL80211_TDLS_SETUP,
6245 	NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN,
6246 	NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK,
6247 	NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK,
6248 };
6249 
6250 /**
6251  * enum nl80211_ap_sme_features - device-integrated AP features
6252  * @NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD: SA Query procedures offloaded to driver
6253  *	when user space indicates support for SA Query procedures offload during
6254  *	"start ap" with %NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT.
6255  */
6256 enum nl80211_ap_sme_features {
6257 	NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD		= 1 << 0,
6258 };
6259 
6260 /**
6261  * enum nl80211_feature_flags - device/driver features
6262  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SK_TX_STATUS: This driver supports reflecting back
6263  *	TX status to the socket error queue when requested with the
6264  *	socket option.
6265  * @NL80211_FEATURE_HT_IBSS: This driver supports IBSS with HT datarates.
6266  * @NL80211_FEATURE_INACTIVITY_TIMER: This driver takes care of freeing up
6267  *	the connected inactive stations in AP mode.
6268  * @NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS: This driver has been tested
6269  *	to work properly to support receiving regulatory hints from
6270  *	cellular base stations.
6271  * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_DEVICE_NEEDS_CHANNEL: (no longer available, only
6272  *	here to reserve the value for API/ABI compatibility)
6273  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SAE: This driver supports simultaneous authentication of
6274  *	equals (SAE) with user space SME (NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE) in station
6275  *	mode
6276  * @NL80211_FEATURE_LOW_PRIORITY_SCAN: This driver supports low priority scan
6277  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_FLUSH: Scan flush is supported
6278  * @NL80211_FEATURE_AP_SCAN: Support scanning using an AP vif
6279  * @NL80211_FEATURE_VIF_TXPOWER: The driver supports per-vif TX power setting
6280  * @NL80211_FEATURE_NEED_OBSS_SCAN: The driver expects userspace to perform
6281  *	OBSS scans and generate 20/40 BSS coex reports. This flag is used only
6282  *	for drivers implementing the CONNECT API, for AUTH/ASSOC it is implied.
6283  * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_CTWIN: P2P GO implementation supports CT Window
6284  *	setting
6285  * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_OPPPS: P2P GO implementation supports opportunistic
6286  *	powersave
6287  * @NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE: The driver supports full state
6288  *	transitions for AP clients. Without this flag (and if the driver
6289  *	doesn't have the AP SME in the device) the driver supports adding
6290  *	stations only when they're associated and adds them in associated
6291  *	state (to later be transitioned into authorized), with this flag
6292  *	they should be added before even sending the authentication reply
6293  *	and then transitioned into authenticated, associated and authorized
6294  *	states using station flags.
6295  *	Note that even for drivers that support this, the default is to add
6296  *	stations in authenticated/associated state, so to add unauthenticated
6297  *	stations the authenticated/associated bits have to be set in the mask.
6298  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ADVERTISE_CHAN_LIMITS: cfg80211 advertises channel limits
6299  *	(HT40, VHT 80/160 MHz) if this flag is set
6300  * @NL80211_FEATURE_USERSPACE_MPM: This driver supports a userspace Mesh
6301  *	Peering Management entity which may be implemented by registering for
6302  *	beacons or NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE events. The mesh beacon is
6303  *	still generated by the driver.
6304  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ACTIVE_MONITOR: This driver supports an active monitor
6305  *	interface. An active monitor interface behaves like a normal monitor
6306  *	interface, but gets added to the driver. It ensures that incoming
6307  *	unicast packets directed at the configured interface address get ACKed.
6308  * @NL80211_FEATURE_AP_MODE_CHAN_WIDTH_CHANGE: This driver supports dynamic
6309  *	channel bandwidth change (e.g., HT 20 <-> 40 MHz channel) during the
6310  *	lifetime of a BSS.
6311  * @NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES: This device adds a DS Parameter
6312  *	Set IE to probe requests.
6313  * @NL80211_FEATURE_WFA_TPC_IE_IN_PROBES: This device adds a WFA TPC Report IE
6314  *	to probe requests.
6315  * @NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET: This device, in client mode, supports Quiet Period
6316  *	requests sent to it by an AP.
6317  * @NL80211_FEATURE_TX_POWER_INSERTION: This device is capable of inserting the
6318  *	current tx power value into the TPC Report IE in the spectrum
6319  *	management TPC Report action frame, and in the Radio Measurement Link
6320  *	Measurement Report action frame.
6321  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION: This driver supports dynamic ACK timeout
6322  *	estimation (dynack). %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK flag attribute is used
6323  *	to enable dynack.
6324  * @NL80211_FEATURE_STATIC_SMPS: Device supports static spatial
6325  *	multiplexing powersave, ie. can turn off all but one chain
6326  *	even on HT connections that should be using more chains.
6327  * @NL80211_FEATURE_DYNAMIC_SMPS: Device supports dynamic spatial
6328  *	multiplexing powersave, ie. can turn off all but one chain
6329  *	and then wake the rest up as required after, for example,
6330  *	rts/cts handshake.
6331  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SUPPORTS_WMM_ADMISSION: the device supports setting up WMM
6332  *	TSPEC sessions (TID aka TSID 0-7) with the %NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS
6333  *	command. Standard IEEE 802.11 TSPEC setup is not yet supported, it
6334  *	needs to be able to handle Block-Ack agreements and other things.
6335  * @NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE: Device supports configuring
6336  *	the vif's MAC address upon creation.
6337  *	See 'macaddr' field in the vif_params (cfg80211.h).
6338  * @NL80211_FEATURE_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Driver supports channel switching when
6339  *	operating as a TDLS peer.
6340  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports using a
6341  *	random MAC address during scan (if the device is unassociated); the
6342  *	%NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR flag may be set for scans and the MAC
6343  *	address mask/value will be used.
6344  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports
6345  *	using a random MAC address for every scan iteration during scheduled
6346  *	scan (while not associated), the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR may
6347  *	be set for scheduled scan and the MAC address mask/value will be used.
6348  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ND_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports using a
6349  *	random MAC address for every scan iteration during "net detect", i.e.
6350  *	scan in unassociated WoWLAN, the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR may
6351  *	be set for scheduled scan and the MAC address mask/value will be used.
6352  */
6353 enum nl80211_feature_flags {
6354 	NL80211_FEATURE_SK_TX_STATUS			= 1 << 0,
6355 	NL80211_FEATURE_HT_IBSS				= 1 << 1,
6356 	NL80211_FEATURE_INACTIVITY_TIMER		= 1 << 2,
6357 	NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS		= 1 << 3,
6358 	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_DEVICE_NEEDS_CHANNEL	= 1 << 4,
6359 	NL80211_FEATURE_SAE				= 1 << 5,
6360 	NL80211_FEATURE_LOW_PRIORITY_SCAN		= 1 << 6,
6361 	NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_FLUSH			= 1 << 7,
6362 	NL80211_FEATURE_AP_SCAN				= 1 << 8,
6363 	NL80211_FEATURE_VIF_TXPOWER			= 1 << 9,
6364 	NL80211_FEATURE_NEED_OBSS_SCAN			= 1 << 10,
6365 	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_CTWIN			= 1 << 11,
6366 	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_OPPPS			= 1 << 12,
6367 	/* bit 13 is reserved */
6368 	NL80211_FEATURE_ADVERTISE_CHAN_LIMITS		= 1 << 14,
6369 	NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE		= 1 << 15,
6370 	NL80211_FEATURE_USERSPACE_MPM			= 1 << 16,
6371 	NL80211_FEATURE_ACTIVE_MONITOR			= 1 << 17,
6372 	NL80211_FEATURE_AP_MODE_CHAN_WIDTH_CHANGE	= 1 << 18,
6373 	NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES	= 1 << 19,
6374 	NL80211_FEATURE_WFA_TPC_IE_IN_PROBES		= 1 << 20,
6375 	NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET				= 1 << 21,
6376 	NL80211_FEATURE_TX_POWER_INSERTION		= 1 << 22,
6377 	NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION		= 1 << 23,
6378 	NL80211_FEATURE_STATIC_SMPS			= 1 << 24,
6379 	NL80211_FEATURE_DYNAMIC_SMPS			= 1 << 25,
6380 	NL80211_FEATURE_SUPPORTS_WMM_ADMISSION		= 1 << 26,
6381 	NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE			= 1 << 27,
6382 	NL80211_FEATURE_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH		= 1 << 28,
6383 	NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR		= 1 << 29,
6384 	NL80211_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR	= 1 << 30,
6385 	NL80211_FEATURE_ND_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR		= 1U << 31,
6386 };
6387 
6388 /**
6389  * enum nl80211_ext_feature_index - bit index of extended features.
6390  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VHT_IBSS: This driver supports IBSS with VHT datarates.
6391  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM: This driver supports RRM. When featured, user can
6392  *	request to use RRM (see %NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM) with
6393  *	%NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests, which will set
6394  *	the ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM flag in the association request even if
6395  *	NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET is not advertised.
6396  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MU_MIMO_AIR_SNIFFER: This device supports MU-MIMO air
6397  *	sniffer which means that it can be configured to hear packets from
6398  *	certain groups which can be configured by the
6399  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA attribute,
6400  *	or can be configured to follow a station by configuring the
6401  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR attribute.
6402  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_START_TIME: This driver includes the actual
6403  *	time the scan started in scan results event. The time is the TSF of
6404  *	the BSS that the interface that requested the scan is connected to
6405  *	(if available).
6406  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_PARENT_TSF: Per BSS, this driver reports the
6407  *	time the last beacon/probe was received. For a non-MLO connection, the
6408  *	time is the TSF of the BSS that the interface that requested the scan is
6409  *	connected to (if available). For an MLO connection, the time is the TSF
6410  *	of the BSS corresponding with link ID specified in the scan request (if
6411  *	specified).
6412  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SET_SCAN_DWELL: This driver supports configuration of
6413  *	channel dwell time.
6414  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY: Driver supports beacon rate
6415  *	configuration (AP/mesh), supporting a legacy (non-HT/VHT) rate.
6416  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT: Driver supports beacon rate
6417  *	configuration (AP/mesh) with HT rates.
6418  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT: Driver supports beacon rate
6419  *	configuration (AP/mesh) with VHT rates.
6420  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_STA: This driver supports Fast Initial Link Setup
6421  *	with user space SME (NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE) in station mode.
6422  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA: This driver supports randomized TA
6423  *	in @NL80211_CMD_FRAME while not associated.
6424  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA_CONNECTED: This driver supports
6425  *	randomized TA in @NL80211_CMD_FRAME while associated.
6426  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI: The driver supports sched_scan
6427  *	for reporting BSSs with better RSSI than the current connected BSS
6428  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI).
6429  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST: With this driver the
6430  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD attribute accepts a list of zero or more
6431  *	RSSI threshold values to monitor rather than exactly one threshold.
6432  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD: Driver SME supports FILS shared key
6433  *	authentication with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
6434  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK: Device wants to do 4-way
6435  *	handshake with PSK in station mode (PSK is passed as part of the connect
6436  *	and associate commands), doing it in the host might not be supported.
6437  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X: Device wants to do doing 4-way
6438  *	handshake with 802.1X in station mode (will pass EAP frames to the host
6439  *	and accept the set_pmk/del_pmk commands), doing it in the host might not
6440  *	be supported.
6441  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME: Driver is capable of overriding
6442  *	the max channel attribute in the FILS request params IE with the
6443  *	actual dwell time.
6444  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Driver accepts broadcast probe
6445  *	response
6446  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE: Driver supports sending
6447  *	the first probe request in each channel at rate of at least 5.5Mbps.
6448  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION: Driver supports
6449  *	probe request tx deferral and suppression
6450  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MFP_OPTIONAL: Driver supports the %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL
6451  *	value in %NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP.
6452  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_SPAN_SCAN: Driver supports low span scan.
6453  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_POWER_SCAN: Driver supports low power scan.
6454  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_HIGH_ACCURACY_SCAN: Driver supports high accuracy scan.
6455  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD: HW/driver will offload DFS actions.
6456  *	Device or driver will do all DFS-related actions by itself,
6457  *	informing user-space about CAC progress, radar detection event,
6458  *	channel change triggered by radar detection event.
6459  *	No need to start CAC from user-space, no need to react to
6460  *	"radar detected" event.
6461  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211: Driver supports sending and
6462  *	receiving control port frames over nl80211 instead of the netdevice.
6463  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT: This driver/device supports
6464  *	(average) ACK signal strength reporting.
6465  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT: Backward-compatible ID
6466  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_TXQS: Driver supports FQ-CoDel-enabled intermediate
6467  *      TXQs.
6468  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_SN: Driver/device supports randomizing the
6469  *	SN in probe request frames if requested by %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN.
6470  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT: Driver/device can omit all data
6471  *	except for supported rates from the probe request content if requested
6472  *	by the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT flag.
6473  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ENABLE_FTM_RESPONDER: Driver supports enabling fine
6474  *	timing measurement responder role.
6475  *
6476  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0: Driver/device confirm that they are
6477  *      able to rekey an in-use key correctly. Userspace must not rekey PTK keys
6478  *      if this flag is not set. Ignoring this can leak clear text packets and/or
6479  *      freeze the connection.
6480  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID: Driver supports "Extended Key ID for
6481  *      Individually Addressed Frames" from IEEE802.11-2016.
6482  *
6483  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AIRTIME_FAIRNESS: Driver supports getting airtime
6484  *	fairness for transmitted packets and has enabled airtime fairness
6485  *	scheduling.
6486  *
6487  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AP_PMKSA_CACHING: Driver/device supports PMKSA caching
6488  *	(set/del PMKSA operations) in AP mode.
6489  *
6490  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD: Obsolete
6491  *
6492  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_STA_TX_PWR: This driver supports controlling tx power
6493  *	to a station.
6494  *
6495  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD: Device wants to do SAE authentication in
6496  *	station mode (SAE password is passed as part of the connect command).
6497  *
6498  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD: The driver supports a single netdev
6499  *	with VLAN tagged frames and separate VLAN-specific netdevs added using
6500  *	vconfig similarly to the Ethernet case.
6501  *
6502  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AQL: The driver supports the Airtime Queue Limit (AQL)
6503  *	feature, which prevents bufferbloat by using the expected transmission
6504  *	time to limit the amount of data buffered in the hardware.
6505  *
6506  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION: The driver supports Beacon protection
6507  *	and can receive key configuration for BIGTK using key indexes 6 and 7.
6508  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION_CLIENT: The driver supports Beacon
6509  *	protection as a client only and cannot transmit protected beacons.
6510  *
6511  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH: The driver can disable the
6512  *	forwarding of preauth frames over the control port. They are then
6513  *	handled as ordinary data frames.
6514  *
6515  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROTECTED_TWT: Driver supports protected TWT frames
6516  *
6517  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DEL_IBSS_STA: The driver supports removing stations
6518  *      in IBSS mode, essentially by dropping their state.
6519  *
6520  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS: management frame registrations
6521  *	are possible for multicast frames and those will be reported properly.
6522  *
6523  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ: This driver supports receiving and
6524  *	reporting scan request with %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ. In order to
6525  *	report %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ, %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ must be
6526  *	included in the scan request.
6527  *
6528  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211_TX_STATUS: The driver
6529  *	can report tx status for control port over nl80211 tx operations.
6530  *
6531  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OPERATING_CHANNEL_VALIDATION: Driver supports Operating
6532  *	Channel Validation (OCV) when using driver's SME for RSNA handshakes.
6533  *
6534  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK: Device wants to do 4-way
6535  *	handshake with PSK in AP mode (PSK is passed as part of the start AP
6536  *	command).
6537  *
6538  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP: Device wants to do SAE authentication
6539  *	in AP mode (SAE password is passed as part of the start AP command).
6540  *
6541  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_DISCOVERY: Driver/device supports FILS discovery
6542  *	frames transmission
6543  *
6544  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Driver/device supports
6545  *	unsolicited broadcast probe response transmission
6546  *
6547  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE: Driver supports beacon rate
6548  *	configuration (AP/mesh) with HE rates.
6549  *
6550  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_LTF: Device supports secure LTF measurement
6551  *      exchange protocol.
6552  *
6553  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_RTT: Device supports secure RTT measurement
6554  *      exchange protocol.
6555  *
6556  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROT_RANGE_NEGO_AND_MEASURE: Device supports management
6557  *      frame protection for all management frames exchanged during the
6558  *      negotiation and range measurement procedure.
6559  *
6560  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_COLOR: The driver supports BSS color collision
6561  *	detection and change announcemnts.
6562  *
6563  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD: Driver running in AP mode supports
6564  *	FILS encryption and decryption for (Re)Association Request and Response
6565  *	frames. Userspace has to share FILS AAD details to the driver by using
6566  *	@NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD.
6567  *
6568  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RADAR_BACKGROUND: Device supports background radar/CAC
6569  *	detection.
6570  *
6571  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_POWERED_ADDR_CHANGE: Device can perform a MAC address
6572  *	change without having to bring the underlying network device down
6573  *	first. For example, in station mode this can be used to vary the
6574  *	origin MAC address prior to a connection to a new AP for privacy
6575  *	or other reasons. Note that certain driver specific restrictions
6576  *	might apply, e.g. no scans in progress, no offchannel operations
6577  *	in progress, and no active connections.
6578  *
6579  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PUNCT: Driver supports preamble puncturing in AP mode.
6580  *
6581  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_NAN: Device supports NAN Pairing which enables
6582  *	authentication, data encryption and message integrity.
6583  *
6584  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AUTH_AND_DEAUTH_RANDOM_TA: Device supports randomized TA
6585  *	in authentication and deauthentication frames sent to unassociated peer
6586  *	using @NL80211_CMD_FRAME.
6587  *
6588  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD: Driver/Device wants to do OWE DH IE
6589  *	handling in station mode.
6590  *
6591  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD_AP: Driver/Device wants to do OWE DH IE
6592  *	handling in AP mode.
6593  *
6594  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_CONCURRENT: The device supports peer-to-peer or
6595  *	ad hoc operation on DFS channels under the control of a concurrent
6596  *	DFS master on the same channel as described in FCC-594280 D01
6597  *	(Section B.3). This, for example, allows P2P GO and P2P clients to
6598  *	operate on DFS channels as long as there's a concurrent BSS connection.
6599  *
6600  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SPP_AMSDU_SUPPORT: The driver has support for SPP
6601  *	(signaling and payload protected) A-MSDUs and this shall be advertised
6602  *	in the RSNXE.
6603  *
6604  * @NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES: number of extended features.
6605  * @MAX_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES: highest extended feature index.
6606  */
6607 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index {
6608 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VHT_IBSS,
6609 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM,
6610 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MU_MIMO_AIR_SNIFFER,
6611 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_START_TIME,
6612 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_PARENT_TSF,
6613 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SET_SCAN_DWELL,
6614 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY,
6615 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT,
6616 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT,
6617 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_STA,
6618 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA,
6619 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA_CONNECTED,
6620 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI,
6621 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST,
6622 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD,
6623 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK,
6624 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X,
6625 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME,
6626 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP,
6627 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE,
6628 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION,
6629 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MFP_OPTIONAL,
6630 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_SPAN_SCAN,
6631 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_POWER_SCAN,
6632 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_HIGH_ACCURACY_SCAN,
6633 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD,
6634 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211,
6635 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT,
6636 	/* we renamed this - stay compatible */
6637 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT = NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT,
6638 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_TXQS,
6639 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_SN,
6640 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT,
6641 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0,
6642 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ENABLE_FTM_RESPONDER,
6643 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AIRTIME_FAIRNESS,
6644 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AP_PMKSA_CACHING,
6645 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD, /* obsolete */
6646 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID,
6647 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_STA_TX_PWR,
6648 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD,
6649 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD,
6650 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AQL,
6651 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION,
6652 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH,
6653 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROTECTED_TWT,
6654 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DEL_IBSS_STA,
6655 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS,
6656 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION_CLIENT,
6657 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ,
6658 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211_TX_STATUS,
6659 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OPERATING_CHANNEL_VALIDATION,
6660 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK,
6661 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP,
6662 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_DISCOVERY,
6663 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP,
6664 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE,
6665 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_LTF,
6666 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_RTT,
6667 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROT_RANGE_NEGO_AND_MEASURE,
6668 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_COLOR,
6669 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD,
6670 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RADAR_BACKGROUND,
6671 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_POWERED_ADDR_CHANGE,
6672 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PUNCT,
6673 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_NAN,
6674 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AUTH_AND_DEAUTH_RANDOM_TA,
6675 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD,
6676 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD_AP,
6677 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_CONCURRENT,
6678 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SPP_AMSDU_SUPPORT,
6679 
6680 	/* add new features before the definition below */
6681 	NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES,
6682 	MAX_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES = NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES - 1
6683 };
6684 
6685 /**
6686  * enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr - optional supported
6687  *	protocols for probe-response offloading by the driver/FW.
6688  *	To be used with the %NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD attribute.
6689  *	Each enum value represents a bit in the bitmap of supported
6690  *	protocols. Typically a subset of probe-requests belonging to a
6691  *	supported protocol will be excluded from offload and uploaded
6692  *	to the host.
6693  *
6694  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS: Support for WPS ver. 1
6695  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS2: Support for WPS ver. 2
6696  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_P2P: Support for P2P
6697  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_80211U: Support for 802.11u
6698  */
6699 enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr {
6700 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS =	1<<0,
6701 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS2 =	1<<1,
6702 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_P2P =	1<<2,
6703 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_80211U =	1<<3,
6704 };
6705 
6706 /**
6707  * enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason - connection request failed reasons
6708  * @NL80211_CONN_FAIL_MAX_CLIENTS: Maximum number of clients that can be
6709  *	handled by the AP is reached.
6710  * @NL80211_CONN_FAIL_BLOCKED_CLIENT: Connection request is rejected due to ACL.
6711  */
6712 enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason {
6713 	NL80211_CONN_FAIL_MAX_CLIENTS,
6714 	NL80211_CONN_FAIL_BLOCKED_CLIENT,
6715 };
6716 
6717 /**
6718  * enum nl80211_timeout_reason - timeout reasons
6719  *
6720  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED: Timeout reason unspecified.
6721  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_SCAN: Scan (AP discovery) timed out.
6722  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_AUTH: Authentication timed out.
6723  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_ASSOC: Association timed out.
6724  */
6725 enum nl80211_timeout_reason {
6726 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED,
6727 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_SCAN,
6728 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_AUTH,
6729 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_ASSOC,
6730 };
6731 
6732 /**
6733  * enum nl80211_scan_flags -  scan request control flags
6734  *
6735  * Scan request control flags are used to control the handling
6736  * of NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN and NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN
6737  * requests.
6738  *
6739  * NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN, NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER, and
6740  * NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY flags are exclusive of each other, i.e., only
6741  * one of them can be used in the request.
6742  *
6743  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_PRIORITY: scan request has low priority
6744  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FLUSH: flush cache before scanning
6745  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_AP: force a scan even if the interface is configured
6746  *	as AP and the beaconing has already been configured. This attribute is
6747  *	dangerous because will destroy stations performance as a lot of frames
6748  *	will be lost while scanning off-channel, therefore it must be used only
6749  *	when really needed
6750  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR: use a random MAC address for this scan (or
6751  *	for scheduled scan: a different one for every scan iteration). When the
6752  *	flag is set, depending on device capabilities the @NL80211_ATTR_MAC and
6753  *	@NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK attributes may also be given in which case only
6754  *	the masked bits will be preserved from the MAC address and the remainder
6755  *	randomised. If the attributes are not given full randomisation (46 bits,
6756  *	locally administered 1, multicast 0) is assumed.
6757  *	This flag must not be requested when the feature isn't supported, check
6758  *	the nl80211 feature flags for the device.
6759  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME: fill the dwell time in the FILS
6760  *	request parameters IE in the probe request
6761  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: accept broadcast probe responses
6762  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE: send probe request frames at
6763  *	rate of at least 5.5M. In case non-OCE AP is discovered in the channel,
6764  *	only the first probe req in the channel will be sent in high rate.
6765  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION: allow probe request
6766  *	tx deferral (dot11FILSProbeDelay shall be set to 15ms)
6767  *	and suppression (if it has received a broadcast Probe Response frame,
6768  *	Beacon frame or FILS Discovery frame from an AP that the STA considers
6769  *	a suitable candidate for (re-)association - suitable in terms of
6770  *	SSID and/or RSSI.
6771  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN: Span corresponds to the total time taken to
6772  *	accomplish the scan. Thus, this flag intends the driver to perform the
6773  *	scan request with lesser span/duration. It is specific to the driver
6774  *	implementations on how this is accomplished. Scan accuracy may get
6775  *	impacted with this flag.
6776  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER: This flag intends the scan attempts to consume
6777  *	optimal possible power. Drivers can resort to their specific means to
6778  *	optimize the power. Scan accuracy may get impacted with this flag.
6779  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY: Accuracy here intends to the extent of scan
6780  *	results obtained. Thus HIGH_ACCURACY scan flag aims to get maximum
6781  *	possible scan results. This flag hints the driver to use the best
6782  *	possible scan configuration to improve the accuracy in scanning.
6783  *	Latency and power use may get impacted with this flag.
6784  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN: randomize the sequence number in probe
6785  *	request frames from this scan to avoid correlation/tracking being
6786  *	possible.
6787  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT: minimize probe request content to
6788  *	only have supported rates and no additional capabilities (unless
6789  *	added by userspace explicitly.)
6790  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ: report scan results with
6791  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ. This also means
6792  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES will not be included.
6793  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_COLOCATED_6GHZ: scan for collocated APs reported by
6794  *	2.4/5 GHz APs. When the flag is set, the scan logic will use the
6795  *	information from the RNR element found in beacons/probe responses
6796  *	received on the 2.4/5 GHz channels to actively scan only the 6GHz
6797  *	channels on which APs are expected to be found. Note that when not set,
6798  *	the scan logic would scan all 6GHz channels, but since transmission of
6799  *	probe requests on non-PSC channels is limited, it is highly likely that
6800  *	these channels would passively be scanned. Also note that when the flag
6801  *	is set, in addition to the colocated APs, PSC channels would also be
6802  *	scanned if the user space has asked for it.
6803  */
6804 enum nl80211_scan_flags {
6805 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_PRIORITY				= 1<<0,
6806 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FLUSH					= 1<<1,
6807 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_AP					= 1<<2,
6808 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR				= 1<<3,
6809 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME			= 1<<4,
6810 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP		= 1<<5,
6811 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE		= 1<<6,
6812 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION	= 1<<7,
6813 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN				= 1<<8,
6814 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER				= 1<<9,
6815 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY				= 1<<10,
6816 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN				= 1<<11,
6817 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT			= 1<<12,
6818 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ				= 1<<13,
6819 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_COLOCATED_6GHZ			= 1<<14,
6820 };
6821 
6822 /**
6823  * enum nl80211_acl_policy - access control policy
6824  *
6825  * Access control policy is applied on a MAC list set by
6826  * %NL80211_CMD_START_AP and %NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL, to
6827  * be used with %NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY.
6828  *
6829  * @NL80211_ACL_POLICY_ACCEPT_UNLESS_LISTED: Deny stations which are
6830  *	listed in ACL, i.e. allow all the stations which are not listed
6831  *	in ACL to authenticate.
6832  * @NL80211_ACL_POLICY_DENY_UNLESS_LISTED: Allow the stations which are listed
6833  *	in ACL, i.e. deny all the stations which are not listed in ACL.
6834  */
6835 enum nl80211_acl_policy {
6836 	NL80211_ACL_POLICY_ACCEPT_UNLESS_LISTED,
6837 	NL80211_ACL_POLICY_DENY_UNLESS_LISTED,
6838 };
6839 
6840 /**
6841  * enum nl80211_smps_mode - SMPS mode
6842  *
6843  * Requested SMPS mode (for AP mode)
6844  *
6845  * @NL80211_SMPS_OFF: SMPS off (use all antennas).
6846  * @NL80211_SMPS_STATIC: static SMPS (use a single antenna)
6847  * @NL80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic smps (start with a single antenna and
6848  *	turn on other antennas after CTS/RTS).
6849  * @__NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST: internal
6850  * @NL80211_SMPS_MAX: highest used enumeration
6851  */
6852 enum nl80211_smps_mode {
6853 	NL80211_SMPS_OFF,
6854 	NL80211_SMPS_STATIC,
6855 	NL80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
6856 
6857 	__NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST,
6858 	NL80211_SMPS_MAX = __NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST - 1
6859 };
6860 
6861 /**
6862  * enum nl80211_radar_event - type of radar event for DFS operation
6863  *
6864  * Type of event to be used with NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT to inform userspace
6865  * about detected radars or success of the channel available check (CAC)
6866  *
6867  * @NL80211_RADAR_DETECTED: A radar pattern has been detected. The channel is
6868  *	now unusable.
6869  * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_FINISHED: Channel Availability Check has been finished,
6870  *	the channel is now available.
6871  * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_ABORTED: Channel Availability Check has been aborted, no
6872  *	change to the channel status.
6873  * @NL80211_RADAR_NOP_FINISHED: The Non-Occupancy Period for this channel is
6874  *	over, channel becomes usable.
6875  * @NL80211_RADAR_PRE_CAC_EXPIRED: Channel Availability Check done on this
6876  *	non-operating channel is expired and no longer valid. New CAC must
6877  *	be done on this channel before starting the operation. This is not
6878  *	applicable for ETSI dfs domain where pre-CAC is valid for ever.
6879  * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_STARTED: Channel Availability Check has been started,
6880  *	should be generated by HW if NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD is enabled.
6881  */
6882 enum nl80211_radar_event {
6883 	NL80211_RADAR_DETECTED,
6884 	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_FINISHED,
6885 	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_ABORTED,
6886 	NL80211_RADAR_NOP_FINISHED,
6887 	NL80211_RADAR_PRE_CAC_EXPIRED,
6888 	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_STARTED,
6889 };
6890 
6891 /**
6892  * enum nl80211_dfs_state - DFS states for channels
6893  *
6894  * Channel states used by the DFS code.
6895  *
6896  * @NL80211_DFS_USABLE: The channel can be used, but channel availability
6897  *	check (CAC) must be performed before using it for AP or IBSS.
6898  * @NL80211_DFS_UNAVAILABLE: A radar has been detected on this channel, it
6899  *	is therefore marked as not available.
6900  * @NL80211_DFS_AVAILABLE: The channel has been CAC checked and is available.
6901  */
6902 enum nl80211_dfs_state {
6903 	NL80211_DFS_USABLE,
6904 	NL80211_DFS_UNAVAILABLE,
6905 	NL80211_DFS_AVAILABLE,
6906 };
6907 
6908 /**
6909  * enum nl80211_protocol_features - nl80211 protocol features
6910  * @NL80211_PROTOCOL_FEATURE_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP: nl80211 supports splitting
6911  *	wiphy dumps (if requested by the application with the attribute
6912  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP. Also supported is filtering the
6913  *	wiphy dump by %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX or
6914  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WDEV.
6915  */
6916 enum nl80211_protocol_features {
6917 	NL80211_PROTOCOL_FEATURE_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP =	1 << 0,
6918 };
6919 
6920 /**
6921  * enum nl80211_crit_proto_id - nl80211 critical protocol identifiers
6922  *
6923  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_UNSPEC: protocol unspecified.
6924  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_DHCP: BOOTP or DHCPv6 protocol.
6925  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_EAPOL: EAPOL protocol.
6926  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_APIPA: APIPA protocol.
6927  * @NUM_NL80211_CRIT_PROTO: must be kept last.
6928  */
6929 enum nl80211_crit_proto_id {
6930 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_UNSPEC,
6931 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_DHCP,
6932 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_EAPOL,
6933 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_APIPA,
6934 	/* add other protocols before this one */
6935 	NUM_NL80211_CRIT_PROTO
6936 };
6937 
6938 /* maximum duration for critical protocol measures */
6939 #define NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_MAX_DURATION		5000 /* msec */
6940 
6941 /**
6942  * enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags - flags for received management frame.
6943  *
6944  * Used by cfg80211_rx_mgmt()
6945  *
6946  * @NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_ANSWERED: frame was answered by device/driver.
6947  * @NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_EXTERNAL_AUTH: Host driver intends to offload
6948  *	the authentication. Exclusively defined for host drivers that
6949  *	advertises the SME functionality but would like the userspace
6950  *	to handle certain authentication algorithms (e.g. SAE).
6951  */
6952 enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags {
6953 	NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_ANSWERED = 1 << 0,
6954 	NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_EXTERNAL_AUTH = 1 << 1,
6955 };
6956 
6957 /*
6958  * If this flag is unset, the lower 24 bits are an OUI, if set
6959  * a Linux nl80211 vendor ID is used (no such IDs are allocated
6960  * yet, so that's not valid so far)
6961  */
6962 #define NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX	0x80000000
6963 
6964 /**
6965  * struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info - vendor command data
6966  * @vendor_id: If the %NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX flag is clear, then the
6967  *	value is a 24-bit OUI; if it is set then a separately allocated ID
6968  *	may be used, but no such IDs are allocated yet. New IDs should be
6969  *	added to this file when needed.
6970  * @subcmd: sub-command ID for the command
6971  */
6972 struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info {
6973 	__u32 vendor_id;
6974 	__u32 subcmd;
6975 };
6976 
6977 /**
6978  * enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability - TDLS peer flags.
6979  *
6980  * Used by tdls_mgmt() to determine which conditional elements need
6981  * to be added to TDLS Setup frames.
6982  *
6983  * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HT: TDLS peer is HT capable.
6984  * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_VHT: TDLS peer is VHT capable.
6985  * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_WMM: TDLS peer is WMM capable.
6986  * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HE: TDLS peer is HE capable.
6987  */
6988 enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability {
6989 	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HT = 1<<0,
6990 	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_VHT = 1<<1,
6991 	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_WMM = 1<<2,
6992 	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HE = 1<<3,
6993 };
6994 
6995 /**
6996  * enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan - scanning plan for scheduled scan
6997  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
6998  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL: interval between scan iterations. In
6999  *	seconds (u32).
7000  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS: number of scan iterations in this
7001  *	scan plan (u32). The last scan plan must not specify this attribute
7002  *	because it will run infinitely. A value of zero is invalid as it will
7003  *	make the scan plan meaningless.
7004  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_MAX: highest scheduled scan plan attribute number
7005  *	currently defined
7006  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST: internal use
7007  */
7008 enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan {
7009 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INVALID,
7010 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL,
7011 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS,
7012 
7013 	/* keep last */
7014 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST,
7015 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_MAX =
7016 		__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST - 1
7017 };
7018 
7019 /**
7020  * struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust - RSSI adjustment parameters.
7021  *
7022  * @band: band of BSS that must match for RSSI value adjustment. The value
7023  *	of this field is according to &enum nl80211_band.
7024  * @delta: value used to adjust the RSSI value of matching BSS in dB.
7025  */
7026 struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust {
7027 	__u8 band;
7028 	__s8 delta;
7029 } __attribute__((packed));
7030 
7031 /**
7032  * enum nl80211_bss_select_attr - attributes for bss selection.
7033  *
7034  * @__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_INVALID: reserved.
7035  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI: Flag indicating only RSSI-based BSS selection
7036  *	is requested.
7037  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF: attribute indicating BSS
7038  *	selection should be done such that the specified band is preferred.
7039  *	When there are multiple BSS-es in the preferred band, the driver
7040  *	shall use RSSI-based BSS selection as a second step. The value of
7041  *	this attribute is according to &enum nl80211_band (u32).
7042  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for
7043  *	BSS-es in the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
7044  *	RSSI-based BSS selection. The attribute value is a packed structure
7045  *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
7046  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_MAX: highest bss select attribute number.
7047  * @__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use.
7048  *
7049  * One and only one of these attributes are found within %NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT
7050  * for %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. It specifies the required BSS selection behaviour
7051  * which the driver shall use.
7052  */
7053 enum nl80211_bss_select_attr {
7054 	__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_INVALID,
7055 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI,
7056 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF,
7057 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST,
7058 
7059 	/* keep last */
7060 	__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
7061 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
7062 };
7063 
7064 /**
7065  * enum nl80211_nan_function_type - NAN function type
7066  *
7067  * Defines the function type of a NAN function
7068  *
7069  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH: function is publish
7070  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE: function is subscribe
7071  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP: function is follow-up
7072  * @__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST: internal use
7073  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_MAX_TYPE: internal use
7074  */
7075 enum nl80211_nan_function_type {
7076 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH,
7077 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE,
7078 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP,
7079 
7080 	/* keep last */
7081 	__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST,
7082 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_MAX_TYPE = __NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST - 1,
7083 };
7084 
7085 /**
7086  * enum nl80211_nan_publish_type - NAN publish tx type
7087  *
7088  * Defines how to send publish Service Discovery Frames
7089  *
7090  * @NL80211_NAN_SOLICITED_PUBLISH: publish function is solicited
7091  * @NL80211_NAN_UNSOLICITED_PUBLISH: publish function is unsolicited
7092  */
7093 enum nl80211_nan_publish_type {
7094 	NL80211_NAN_SOLICITED_PUBLISH = 1 << 0,
7095 	NL80211_NAN_UNSOLICITED_PUBLISH = 1 << 1,
7096 };
7097 
7098 /**
7099  * enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason - NAN functions termination reason
7100  *
7101  * Defines termination reasons of a NAN function
7102  *
7103  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST: requested by user
7104  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_TTL_EXPIRED: timeout
7105  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_ERROR: errored
7106  */
7107 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason {
7108 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST,
7109 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_TTL_EXPIRED,
7110 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_ERROR,
7111 };
7112 
7113 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN 6
7114 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_SPEC_INFO_MAX_LEN 0xff
7115 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF_MAX_LEN 0xff
7116 
7117 /**
7118  * enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes - NAN function attributes
7119  * @__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INVALID: invalid
7120  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type (u8).
7121  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID: 6 bytes of the service ID hash as
7122  *	specified in NAN spec. This is a binary attribute.
7123  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_TYPE: relevant if the function's type is
7124  *	publish. Defines the transmission type for the publish Service Discovery
7125  *	Frame, see &enum nl80211_nan_publish_type. Its type is u8.
7126  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_BCAST: relevant if the function is a solicited
7127  *	publish. Should the solicited publish Service Discovery Frame be sent to
7128  *	the NAN Broadcast address. This is a flag.
7129  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE_ACTIVE: relevant if the function's type is
7130  *	subscribe. Is the subscribe active. This is a flag.
7131  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_ID: relevant if the function's type is follow up.
7132  *	The instance ID for the follow up Service Discovery Frame. This is u8.
7133  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_REQ_ID: relevant if the function's type
7134  *	is follow up. This is a u8.
7135  *	The requester instance ID for the follow up Service Discovery Frame.
7136  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_DEST: the MAC address of the recipient of the
7137  *	follow up Service Discovery Frame. This is a binary attribute.
7138  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_CLOSE_RANGE: is this function limited for devices in a
7139  *	close range. The range itself (RSSI) is defined by the device.
7140  *	This is a flag.
7141  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TTL: strictly positive number of DWs this function should
7142  *	stay active. If not present infinite TTL is assumed. This is a u32.
7143  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_INFO: array of bytes describing the service
7144  *	specific info. This is a binary attribute.
7145  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF: Service Receive Filter. This is a nested attribute.
7146  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes.
7147  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_RX_MATCH_FILTER: Receive Matching filter. This is a nested
7148  *	attribute. It is a list of binary values.
7149  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TX_MATCH_FILTER: Transmit Matching filter. This is a
7150  *	nested attribute. It is a list of binary values.
7151  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INSTANCE_ID: The instance ID of the function.
7152  *	Its type is u8 and it cannot be 0.
7153  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON: NAN function termination reason.
7154  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason.
7155  *
7156  * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR: internal
7157  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN function attribute
7158  */
7159 enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes {
7160 	__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INVALID,
7161 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE,
7162 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID,
7163 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_TYPE,
7164 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_BCAST,
7165 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE_ACTIVE,
7166 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_ID,
7167 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_REQ_ID,
7168 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_DEST,
7169 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_CLOSE_RANGE,
7170 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TTL,
7171 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_INFO,
7172 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF,
7173 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_RX_MATCH_FILTER,
7174 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TX_MATCH_FILTER,
7175 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INSTANCE_ID,
7176 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON,
7177 
7178 	/* keep last */
7179 	NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR,
7180 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR - 1
7181 };
7182 
7183 /**
7184  * enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes - NAN Service Response filter attributes
7185  * @__NL80211_NAN_SRF_INVALID: invalid
7186  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_INCLUDE: present if the include bit of the SRF set.
7187  *	This is a flag.
7188  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF: Bloom Filter. Present if and only if
7189  *	%NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS isn't present. This attribute is binary.
7190  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF_IDX: index of the Bloom Filter. Mandatory if
7191  *	%NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF is present. This is a u8.
7192  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS: list of MAC addresses for the SRF. Present if
7193  *	and only if %NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF isn't present. This is a nested
7194  *	attribute. Each nested attribute is a MAC address.
7195  * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR: internal
7196  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN SRF attribute
7197  */
7198 enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes {
7199 	__NL80211_NAN_SRF_INVALID,
7200 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_INCLUDE,
7201 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF,
7202 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF_IDX,
7203 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS,
7204 
7205 	/* keep last */
7206 	NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR,
7207 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR - 1,
7208 };
7209 
7210 /**
7211  * enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes - NAN match attributes
7212  * @__NL80211_NAN_MATCH_INVALID: invalid
7213  * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_LOCAL: the local function that had the
7214  *	match. This is a nested attribute.
7215  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes.
7216  * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_PEER: the peer function
7217  *	that caused the match. This is a nested attribute.
7218  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes.
7219  *
7220  * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR: internal
7221  * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN match attribute
7222  */
7223 enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes {
7224 	__NL80211_NAN_MATCH_INVALID,
7225 	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_LOCAL,
7226 	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_PEER,
7227 
7228 	/* keep last */
7229 	NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR,
7230 	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR - 1
7231 };
7232 
7233 /**
7234  * enum nl80211_external_auth_action - Action to perform with external
7235  *     authentication request. Used by NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION.
7236  * @NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_START: Start the authentication.
7237  * @NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ABORT: Abort the ongoing authentication.
7238  */
7239 enum nl80211_external_auth_action {
7240 	NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_START,
7241 	NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ABORT,
7242 };
7243 
7244 /**
7245  * enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attributes - fine timing measurement
7246  *	responder attributes
7247  * @__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7248  * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_ENABLED: FTM responder is enabled
7249  * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI: The content of Measurement Report Element
7250  *	(9.4.2.22 in 802.11-2016) with type 8 - LCI (9.4.2.22.10),
7251  *	i.e. starting with the measurement token
7252  * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC: The content of Measurement Report Element
7253  *	(9.4.2.22 in 802.11-2016) with type 11 - Civic (Section 9.4.2.22.13),
7254  *	i.e. starting with the measurement token
7255  * @__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7256  * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest FTM responder attribute.
7257  */
7258 enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attributes {
7259 	__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
7260 
7261 	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_ENABLED,
7262 	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI,
7263 	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC,
7264 
7265 	/* keep last */
7266 	__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST,
7267 	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7268 };
7269 
7270 /*
7271  * enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics
7272  *
7273  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS
7274  * when getting FTM responder statistics.
7275  *
7276  * @__NL80211_FTM_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
7277  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_SUCCESS_NUM: number of FTM sessions in which all frames
7278  *	were ssfully answered (u32)
7279  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_PARTIAL_NUM: number of FTM sessions in which part of the
7280  *	frames were successfully answered (u32)
7281  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_FAILED_NUM: number of failed FTM sessions (u32)
7282  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_ASAP_NUM: number of ASAP sessions (u32)
7283  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_NON_ASAP_NUM: number of non-ASAP sessions (u32)
7284  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_TOTAL_DURATION_MSEC: total sessions durations - gives an
7285  *	indication of how much time the responder was busy (u64, msec)
7286  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_UNKNOWN_TRIGGERS_NUM: number of unknown FTM triggers -
7287  *	triggers from initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation
7288  *	phase with the responder (u32)
7289  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_RESCHEDULE_REQUESTS_NUM: number of FTM reschedule requests
7290  *	- initiator asks for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled
7291  *	FTM slot (u32)
7292  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_OUT_OF_WINDOW_TRIGGERS_NUM: number of FTM triggers out of
7293  *	scheduled window (u32)
7294  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_PAD: used for padding, ignore
7295  * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal
7296  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_MAX: highest possible FTM responder stats attribute
7297  */
7298 enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats {
7299 	__NL80211_FTM_STATS_INVALID,
7300 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_SUCCESS_NUM,
7301 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_PARTIAL_NUM,
7302 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_FAILED_NUM,
7303 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_ASAP_NUM,
7304 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_NON_ASAP_NUM,
7305 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_TOTAL_DURATION_MSEC,
7306 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_UNKNOWN_TRIGGERS_NUM,
7307 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_RESCHEDULE_REQUESTS_NUM,
7308 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_OUT_OF_WINDOW_TRIGGERS_NUM,
7309 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_PAD,
7310 
7311 	/* keep last */
7312 	__NL80211_FTM_STATS_AFTER_LAST,
7313 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_MAX = __NL80211_FTM_STATS_AFTER_LAST - 1
7314 };
7315 
7316 /**
7317  * enum nl80211_preamble - frame preamble types
7318  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_LEGACY: legacy (HR/DSSS, OFDM, ERP PHY) preamble
7319  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_HT: HT preamble
7320  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_VHT: VHT preamble
7321  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_DMG: DMG preamble
7322  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_HE: HE preamble
7323  */
7324 enum nl80211_preamble {
7325 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_LEGACY,
7326 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_HT,
7327 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_VHT,
7328 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_DMG,
7329 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_HE,
7330 };
7331 
7332 /**
7333  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type - peer measurement types
7334  * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_INVALID: invalid/unused, needed as we use
7335  *	these numbers also for attributes
7336  *
7337  * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_FTM: flight time measurement
7338  *
7339  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES: internal
7340  * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_MAX: highest type number
7341  */
7342 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type {
7343 	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_INVALID,
7344 
7345 	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_FTM,
7346 
7347 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES,
7348 	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES - 1
7349 };
7350 
7351 /**
7352  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status - peer measurement status
7353  * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_SUCCESS: measurement completed successfully
7354  * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_REFUSED: measurement was locally refused
7355  * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_TIMEOUT: measurement timed out
7356  * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE: measurement failed, a type-dependent
7357  *	reason may be available in the response data
7358  */
7359 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status {
7360 	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_SUCCESS,
7361 	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_REFUSED,
7362 	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_TIMEOUT,
7363 	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE,
7364 };
7365 
7366 /**
7367  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req - peer measurement request attributes
7368  * @__NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7369  *
7370  * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_DATA: This is a nested attribute with measurement
7371  *	type-specific request data inside. The attributes used are from the
7372  *	enums named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_req.
7373  * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_GET_AP_TSF: include AP TSF timestamp, if supported
7374  *	(flag attribute)
7375  *
7376  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS: internal
7377  * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7378  */
7379 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req {
7380 	__NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_INVALID,
7381 
7382 	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_DATA,
7383 	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_GET_AP_TSF,
7384 
7385 	/* keep last */
7386 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS,
7387 	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS - 1
7388 };
7389 
7390 /**
7391  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp - peer measurement response attributes
7392  * @__NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7393  *
7394  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_DATA: This is a nested attribute with measurement
7395  *	type-specific results inside. The attributes used are from the enums
7396  *	named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_resp.
7397  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_STATUS: u32 value with the measurement status
7398  *	(using values from &enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status.)
7399  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_HOST_TIME: host time (%CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the
7400  *	result was measured; this value is not expected to be accurate to
7401  *	more than 20ms. (u64, nanoseconds)
7402  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_AP_TSF: TSF of the AP that the interface
7403  *	doing the measurement is connected to when the result was measured.
7404  *	This shall be accurately reported if supported and requested
7405  *	(u64, usec)
7406  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_FINAL: If results are sent to the host partially
7407  *	(*e.g. with FTM per-burst data) this flag will be cleared on all but
7408  *	the last result; if all results are combined it's set on the single
7409  *	result.
7410  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_PAD: padding for 64-bit attributes, ignore
7411  *
7412  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS: internal
7413  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7414  */
7415 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp {
7416 	__NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
7417 
7418 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_DATA,
7419 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_STATUS,
7420 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_HOST_TIME,
7421 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_AP_TSF,
7422 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_FINAL,
7423 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_PAD,
7424 
7425 	/* keep last */
7426 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS,
7427 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS - 1
7428 };
7429 
7430 /**
7431  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs - peer attributes for measurement
7432  * @__NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7433  *
7434  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_ADDR: peer's MAC address
7435  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_CHAN: channel definition, nested, using top-level
7436  *	attributes like %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ etc.
7437  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_REQ: This is a nested attribute indexed by
7438  *	measurement type, with attributes from the
7439  *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req inside.
7440  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_RESP: This is a nested attribute indexed by
7441  *	measurement type, with attributes from the
7442  *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp inside.
7443  *
7444  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS: internal
7445  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7446  */
7447 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs {
7448 	__NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_INVALID,
7449 
7450 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_ADDR,
7451 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_CHAN,
7452 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_REQ,
7453 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_RESP,
7454 
7455 	/* keep last */
7456 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS,
7457 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS - 1,
7458 };
7459 
7460 /**
7461  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs - peer measurement attributes
7462  * @__NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7463  *
7464  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX_PEERS: u32 attribute used for capability
7465  *	advertisement only, indicates the maximum number of peers
7466  *	measurements can be done with in a single request
7467  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_REPORT_AP_TSF: flag attribute in capability
7468  *	indicating that the connected AP's TSF can be reported in
7469  *	measurement results
7470  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_RANDOMIZE_MAC_ADDR: flag attribute in capability
7471  *	indicating that MAC address randomization is supported.
7472  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_TYPE_CAPA: capabilities reported by the device,
7473  *	this contains a nesting indexed by measurement type, and
7474  *	type-specific capabilities inside, which are from the enums
7475  *	named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_capa.
7476  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_PEERS: nested attribute, the nesting index is
7477  *	meaningless, just a list of peers to measure with, with the
7478  *	sub-attributes taken from
7479  *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs.
7480  *
7481  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR: internal
7482  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7483  */
7484 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs {
7485 	__NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_INVALID,
7486 
7487 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX_PEERS,
7488 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_REPORT_AP_TSF,
7489 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_RANDOMIZE_MAC_ADDR,
7490 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_TYPE_CAPA,
7491 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_PEERS,
7492 
7493 	/* keep last */
7494 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR,
7495 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR - 1
7496 };
7497 
7498 /**
7499  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_capa - FTM capabilities
7500  * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7501  *
7502  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_ASAP: flag attribute indicating ASAP mode
7503  *	is supported
7504  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_ASAP: flag attribute indicating non-ASAP
7505  *	mode is supported
7506  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_LCI: flag attribute indicating if LCI
7507  *	data can be requested during the measurement
7508  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_CIVICLOC: flag attribute indicating if civic
7509  *	location data can be requested during the measurement
7510  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_PREAMBLES: u32 bitmap attribute of bits
7511  *	from &enum nl80211_preamble.
7512  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_BANDWIDTHS: bitmap of values from
7513  *	&enum nl80211_chan_width indicating the supported channel
7514  *	bandwidths for FTM. Note that a higher channel bandwidth may be
7515  *	configured to allow for other measurements types with different
7516  *	bandwidth requirement in the same measurement.
7517  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_BURSTS_EXPONENT: u32 attribute indicating
7518  *	the maximum bursts exponent that can be used (if not present anything
7519  *	is valid)
7520  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_FTMS_PER_BURST: u32 attribute indicating
7521  *	the maximum FTMs per burst (if not present anything is valid)
7522  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED: flag attribute indicating if
7523  *	trigger based ranging measurement is supported
7524  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED: flag attribute indicating
7525  *	if non-trigger-based ranging measurement is supported
7526  *
7527  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR: internal
7528  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7529  */
7530 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_capa {
7531 	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_INVALID,
7532 
7533 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_ASAP,
7534 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_ASAP,
7535 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_LCI,
7536 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_CIVICLOC,
7537 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_PREAMBLES,
7538 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_BANDWIDTHS,
7539 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_BURSTS_EXPONENT,
7540 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_FTMS_PER_BURST,
7541 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED,
7542 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED,
7543 
7544 	/* keep last */
7545 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR,
7546 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR - 1
7547 };
7548 
7549 /**
7550  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_req - FTM request attributes
7551  * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7552  *
7553  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_ASAP: ASAP mode requested (flag)
7554  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_PREAMBLE: preamble type (see
7555  *	&enum nl80211_preamble), optional for DMG (u32)
7556  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP: number of bursts exponent as in
7557  *	802.11-2016 9.4.2.168 "Fine Timing Measurement Parameters element"
7558  *	(u8, 0-15, optional with default 15 i.e. "no preference")
7559  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_PERIOD: interval between bursts in units
7560  *	of 100ms (u16, optional with default 0)
7561  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_DURATION: burst duration, as in 802.11-2016
7562  *	Table 9-257 "Burst Duration field encoding" (u8, 0-15, optional with
7563  *	default 15 i.e. "no preference")
7564  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST: number of successful FTM frames
7565  *	requested per burst
7566  *	(u8, 0-31, optional with default 0 i.e. "no preference")
7567  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_RETRIES: number of FTMR frame retries
7568  *	(u8, default 3)
7569  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_LCI: request LCI data (flag)
7570  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_CIVICLOC: request civic location data
7571  *	(flag)
7572  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED: request trigger based ranging
7573  *	measurement (flag).
7574  *	This attribute and %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED are
7575  *	mutually exclusive.
7576  *      if neither %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED nor
7577  *	%NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set, EDCA based
7578  *	ranging will be used.
7579  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED: request non-trigger-based
7580  *	ranging measurement (flag)
7581  *	This attribute and %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED are
7582  *	mutually exclusive.
7583  *      if neither %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED nor
7584  *	%NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set, EDCA based
7585  *	ranging will be used.
7586  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_LMR_FEEDBACK: negotiate for LMR feedback. Only
7587  *	valid if either %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED or
7588  *	%NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set.
7589  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BSS_COLOR: optional. The BSS color of the
7590  *	responder. Only valid if %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED
7591  *	or %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED is set.
7592  *
7593  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR: internal
7594  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7595  */
7596 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_req {
7597 	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_INVALID,
7598 
7599 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_ASAP,
7600 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_PREAMBLE,
7601 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP,
7602 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_PERIOD,
7603 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_DURATION,
7604 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST,
7605 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_RETRIES,
7606 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_LCI,
7607 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_CIVICLOC,
7608 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED,
7609 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED,
7610 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_LMR_FEEDBACK,
7611 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BSS_COLOR,
7612 
7613 	/* keep last */
7614 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR,
7615 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR - 1
7616 };
7617 
7618 /**
7619  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons - FTM failure reasons
7620  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_UNSPECIFIED: unspecified failure, not used
7621  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_NO_RESPONSE: no response from the FTM responder
7622  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_REJECTED: FTM responder rejected measurement
7623  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_WRONG_CHANNEL: we already know the peer is
7624  *	on a different channel, so can't measure (if we didn't know, we'd
7625  *	try and get no response)
7626  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_NOT_CAPABLE: peer can't actually do FTM
7627  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_INVALID_TIMESTAMP: invalid T1/T4 timestamps
7628  *	received
7629  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY: peer reports busy, you may retry
7630  *	later (see %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME)
7631  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_BAD_CHANGED_PARAMS: parameters were changed
7632  *	by the peer and are no longer supported
7633  */
7634 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons {
7635 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_UNSPECIFIED,
7636 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_NO_RESPONSE,
7637 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_REJECTED,
7638 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_WRONG_CHANNEL,
7639 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_NOT_CAPABLE,
7640 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_INVALID_TIMESTAMP,
7641 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY,
7642 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_BAD_CHANGED_PARAMS,
7643 };
7644 
7645 /**
7646  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_resp - FTM response attributes
7647  * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7648  *
7649  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FAIL_REASON: FTM-specific failure reason
7650  *	(u32, optional)
7651  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_INDEX: optional, if bursts are reported
7652  *	as separate results then it will be the burst index 0...(N-1) and
7653  *	the top level will indicate partial results (u32)
7654  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_ATTEMPTS: number of FTM Request frames
7655  *	transmitted (u32, optional)
7656  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_SUCCESSES: number of FTM Request frames
7657  *	that were acknowledged (u32, optional)
7658  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME: retry time received from the
7659  *	busy peer (u32, seconds)
7660  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP: actual number of bursts exponent
7661  *	used by the responder (similar to request, u8)
7662  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_DURATION: actual burst duration used by
7663  *	the responder (similar to request, u8)
7664  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST: actual FTMs per burst used
7665  *	by the responder (similar to request, u8)
7666  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_AVG: average RSSI across all FTM action
7667  *	frames (optional, s32, 1/2 dBm)
7668  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_SPREAD: RSSI spread across all FTM action
7669  *	frames (optional, s32, 1/2 dBm)
7670  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_TX_RATE: bitrate we used for the response to the
7671  *	FTM action frame (optional, nested, using &enum nl80211_rate_info
7672  *	attributes)
7673  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RX_RATE: bitrate the responder used for the FTM
7674  *	action frame (optional, nested, using &enum nl80211_rate_info attrs)
7675  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_AVG: average RTT (s64, picoseconds, optional
7676  *	but one of RTT/DIST must be present)
7677  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_VARIANCE: RTT variance (u64, ps^2, note that
7678  *	standard deviation is the square root of variance, optional)
7679  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_SPREAD: RTT spread (u64, picoseconds,
7680  *	optional)
7681  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_AVG: average distance (s64, mm, optional
7682  *	but one of RTT/DIST must be present)
7683  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_VARIANCE: distance variance (u64, mm^2, note
7684  *	that standard deviation is the square root of variance, optional)
7685  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_SPREAD: distance spread (u64, mm, optional)
7686  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI: LCI data from peer (binary, optional);
7687  *	this is the contents of the Measurement Report Element (802.11-2016
7688  *	9.4.2.22.1) starting with the Measurement Token, with Measurement
7689  *	Type 8.
7690  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC: civic location data from peer
7691  *	(binary, optional);
7692  *	this is the contents of the Measurement Report Element (802.11-2016
7693  *	9.4.2.22.1) starting with the Measurement Token, with Measurement
7694  *	Type 11.
7695  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_PAD: ignore, for u64/s64 padding only
7696  *
7697  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR: internal
7698  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7699  */
7700 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_resp {
7701 	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
7702 
7703 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FAIL_REASON,
7704 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_INDEX,
7705 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_ATTEMPTS,
7706 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_SUCCESSES,
7707 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME,
7708 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP,
7709 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_DURATION,
7710 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST,
7711 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_AVG,
7712 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_SPREAD,
7713 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_TX_RATE,
7714 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RX_RATE,
7715 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_AVG,
7716 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_VARIANCE,
7717 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_SPREAD,
7718 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_AVG,
7719 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_VARIANCE,
7720 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_SPREAD,
7721 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI,
7722 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC,
7723 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_PAD,
7724 
7725 	/* keep last */
7726 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR,
7727 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR - 1
7728 };
7729 
7730 /**
7731  * enum nl80211_obss_pd_attributes - OBSS packet detection attributes
7732  * @__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7733  *
7734  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MIN_OFFSET: the OBSS PD minimum tx power offset.
7735  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX_OFFSET: the OBSS PD maximum tx power offset.
7736  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_NON_SRG_MAX_OFFSET: the non-SRG OBSS PD maximum
7737  *	tx power offset.
7738  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_BSS_COLOR_BITMAP: bitmap that indicates the BSS color
7739  *	values used by members of the SRG.
7740  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_PARTIAL_BSSID_BITMAP: bitmap that indicates the partial
7741  *	BSSID values used by members of the SRG.
7742  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_SR_CTRL: The SR Control field of SRP element.
7743  *
7744  * @__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7745  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX: highest OBSS PD attribute.
7746  */
7747 enum nl80211_obss_pd_attributes {
7748 	__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_INVALID,
7749 
7750 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MIN_OFFSET,
7751 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX_OFFSET,
7752 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_NON_SRG_MAX_OFFSET,
7753 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_BSS_COLOR_BITMAP,
7754 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_PARTIAL_BSSID_BITMAP,
7755 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_SR_CTRL,
7756 
7757 	/* keep last */
7758 	__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST,
7759 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7760 };
7761 
7762 /**
7763  * enum nl80211_bss_color_attributes - BSS Color attributes
7764  * @__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7765  *
7766  * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_COLOR: the current BSS Color.
7767  * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_DISABLED: is BSS coloring disabled.
7768  * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_PARTIAL: the AID equation to be used..
7769  *
7770  * @__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7771  * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_MAX: highest BSS Color attribute.
7772  */
7773 enum nl80211_bss_color_attributes {
7774 	__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_INVALID,
7775 
7776 	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_COLOR,
7777 	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_DISABLED,
7778 	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_PARTIAL,
7779 
7780 	/* keep last */
7781 	__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST,
7782 	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7783 };
7784 
7785 /**
7786  * enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes - interface type AKM attributes
7787  * @__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7788  *
7789  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing a flag
7790  *	attribute for each interface type that supports AKM suites specified in
7791  *	%NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES
7792  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES: an array of u32. Used to indicate supported
7793  *	AKM suites for the specified interface types.
7794  *
7795  * @__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7796  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_MAX: highest interface type AKM attribute.
7797  */
7798 enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes {
7799 	__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_INVALID,
7800 
7801 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_IFTYPES,
7802 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES,
7803 
7804 	/* keep last */
7805 	__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST,
7806 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7807 };
7808 
7809 /**
7810  * enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes - FILS discovery configuration
7811  * from IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
7812  *
7813  * @__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7814  *
7815  * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MIN: Minimum packet interval (u32, TU).
7816  *	Allowed range: 0..10000 (TU = Time Unit)
7817  * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MAX: Maximum packet interval (u32, TU).
7818  *	Allowed range: 0..10000 (TU = Time Unit). If set to 0, the feature is disabled.
7819  * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_TMPL: Template data for FILS discovery action
7820  *	frame including the headers.
7821  *
7822  * @__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7823  * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute
7824  */
7825 enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes {
7826 	__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INVALID,
7827 
7828 	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MIN,
7829 	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MAX,
7830 	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_TMPL,
7831 
7832 	/* keep last */
7833 	__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST,
7834 	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST - 1
7835 };
7836 
7837 /*
7838  * FILS discovery template minimum length with action frame headers and
7839  * mandatory fields.
7840  */
7841 #define NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_TMPL_MIN_LEN 42
7842 
7843 /**
7844  * enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes - Unsolicited broadcast probe
7845  *	response configuration. Applicable only in 6GHz.
7846  *
7847  * @__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7848  *
7849  * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INT: Maximum packet interval (u32, TU).
7850  *	Allowed range: 0..20 (TU = Time Unit). IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0
7851  *	26.17.2.3.2 (AP behavior for fast passive scanning). If set to 0, the feature is
7852  *	disabled.
7853  * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_TMPL: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
7854  *	frame template (binary).
7855  *
7856  * @__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7857  * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute
7858  */
7859 enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes {
7860 	__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
7861 
7862 	NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INT,
7863 	NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_TMPL,
7864 
7865 	/* keep last */
7866 	__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST,
7867 	NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_MAX =
7868 		__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST - 1
7869 };
7870 
7871 /**
7872  * enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism - The mechanism(s) allowed for SAE PWE
7873  *	derivation. Applicable only when WPA3-Personal SAE authentication is
7874  *	used.
7875  *
7876  * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED: not specified, used internally to indicate that
7877  *	attribute is not present from userspace.
7878  * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK: hunting-and-pecking loop only
7879  * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT: hash-to-element only
7880  * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH: both hunting-and-pecking loop and hash-to-element
7881  *	can be used.
7882  */
7883 enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism {
7884 	NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED,
7885 	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK,
7886 	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT,
7887 	NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH,
7888 };
7889 
7890 /**
7891  * enum nl80211_sar_type - type of SAR specs
7892  *
7893  * @NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER: power limitation specified in 0.25dBm unit
7894  *
7895  * @NUM_NL80211_SAR_TYPE: internal
7896  */
7897 enum nl80211_sar_type {
7898 	NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER,
7899 
7900 	/* add new type here */
7901 
7902 	/* Keep last */
7903 	NUM_NL80211_SAR_TYPE,
7904 };
7905 
7906 /**
7907  * enum nl80211_sar_attrs - Attributes for SAR spec
7908  *
7909  * @__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7910  *
7911  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_TYPE: the SAR type as defined in &enum nl80211_sar_type.
7912  *
7913  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS: Nested array of SAR power
7914  *	limit specifications. Each specification contains a set
7915  *	of %nl80211_sar_specs_attrs.
7916  *
7917  *	For SET operation, it contains array of %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER
7918  *	and %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX.
7919  *
7920  *	For sar_capa dump, it contains array of
7921  *	%NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ
7922  *	and %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ.
7923  *
7924  * @__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7925  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_MAX: highest sar attribute
7926  *
7927  * These attributes are used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPEC
7928  */
7929 enum nl80211_sar_attrs {
7930 	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_INVALID,
7931 
7932 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_TYPE,
7933 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS,
7934 
7935 	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST,
7936 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7937 };
7938 
7939 /**
7940  * enum nl80211_sar_specs_attrs - Attributes for SAR power limit specs
7941  *
7942  * @__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_INVALID: Invalid
7943  *
7944  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER: Required (s32)value to specify the actual
7945  *	power limit value in units of 0.25 dBm if type is
7946  *	NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER. (i.e., a value of 44 represents 11 dBm).
7947  *	0 means userspace doesn't have SAR limitation on this associated range.
7948  *
7949  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX: Required (u32) value to specify the
7950  *	index of exported freq range table and the associated power limitation
7951  *	is applied to this range.
7952  *
7953  *	Userspace isn't required to set all the ranges advertised by WLAN driver,
7954  *	and userspace can skip some certain ranges. These skipped ranges don't
7955  *	have SAR limitations, and they are same as setting the
7956  *	%NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER to any unreasonable high value because any
7957  *	value higher than regulatory allowed value just means SAR power
7958  *	limitation is removed, but it's required to set at least one range.
7959  *	It's not allowed to set duplicated range in one SET operation.
7960  *
7961  *	Every SET operation overwrites previous SET operation.
7962  *
7963  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ: Required (u32) value to specify the start
7964  *	frequency of this range edge when registering SAR capability to wiphy.
7965  *	It's not a channel center frequency. The unit is kHz.
7966  *
7967  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ: Required (u32) value to specify the end
7968  *	frequency of this range edge when registering SAR capability to wiphy.
7969  *	It's not a channel center frequency. The unit is kHz.
7970  *
7971  * @__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST: Internal
7972  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_MAX: highest sar specs attribute
7973  */
7974 enum nl80211_sar_specs_attrs {
7975 	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_INVALID,
7976 
7977 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER,
7978 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX,
7979 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ,
7980 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ,
7981 
7982 	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST,
7983 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_MAX = __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST - 1,
7984 };
7985 
7986 /**
7987  * enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes - multiple BSSID (MBSSID) and enhanced
7988  * multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA) in AP mode.
7989  * Kernel uses some of these attributes to advertise driver's support for
7990  * MBSSID and EMA.
7991  * Remaining attributes should be used by the userspace to configure the
7992  * features.
7993  *
7994  * @__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7995  *
7996  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_INTERFACES: Used by the kernel to advertise
7997  *	the maximum number of MBSSID interfaces supported by the driver.
7998  *	Driver should indicate MBSSID support by setting
7999  *	wiphy->mbssid_max_interfaces to a value more than or equal to 2.
8000  *
8001  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_EMA_PROFILE_PERIODICITY: Used by the kernel
8002  *	to advertise the maximum profile periodicity supported by the driver
8003  *	if EMA is enabled. Driver should indicate EMA support to the userspace
8004  *	by setting wiphy->ema_max_profile_periodicity to
8005  *	a non-zero value.
8006  *
8007  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INDEX: Mandatory parameter to pass the index of
8008  *	this BSS (u8) in the multiple BSSID set.
8009  *	Value must be set to 0 for the transmitting interface and non-zero for
8010  *	all non-transmitting interfaces. The userspace will be responsible
8011  *	for using unique indices for the interfaces.
8012  *	Range: 0 to wiphy->mbssid_max_interfaces-1.
8013  *
8014  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_IFINDEX: Mandatory parameter for
8015  *	a non-transmitted profile which provides the interface index (u32) of
8016  *	the transmitted profile. The value must match one of the interface
8017  *	indices advertised by the kernel. Optional if the interface being set up
8018  *	is the transmitting one, however, if provided then the value must match
8019  *	the interface index of the same.
8020  *
8021  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_EMA: Flag used to enable EMA AP feature.
8022  *	Setting this flag is permitted only if the driver advertises EMA support
8023  *	by setting wiphy->ema_max_profile_periodicity to non-zero.
8024  *
8025  * @__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST: Internal
8026  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute
8027  */
8028 enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes {
8029 	__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID,
8030 
8031 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_INTERFACES,
8032 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_EMA_PROFILE_PERIODICITY,
8033 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INDEX,
8034 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_IFINDEX,
8035 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_EMA,
8036 
8037 	/* keep last */
8038 	__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST,
8039 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST - 1,
8040 };
8041 
8042 /**
8043  * enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags - AP settings flags
8044  *
8045  * @NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: AP supports external
8046  *	authentication.
8047  * @NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT: Userspace supports SA Query
8048  *	procedures offload to driver. If driver advertises
8049  *	%NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD in AP SME features, userspace shall
8050  *	ignore SA Query procedures and validations when this flag is set by
8051  *	userspace.
8052  */
8053 enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags {
8054 	NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT	= 1 << 0,
8055 	NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT	= 1 << 1,
8056 };
8057 
8058 /**
8059  * enum nl80211_wiphy_radio_attrs - wiphy radio attributes
8060  *
8061  * @__NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
8062  *
8063  * @NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_INDEX: Index of this radio (u32)
8064  * @NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE: Frequency range supported by this
8065  *	radio. Attribute may be present multiple times.
8066  * @NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATION: Supported interface
8067  *	combination for this radio. Attribute may be present multiple times
8068  *	and contains attributes defined in &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs.
8069  * @NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_ANTENNA_MASK: bitmask (u32) of antennas
8070  *	connected to this radio.
8071  *
8072  * @__NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_LAST: Internal
8073  * @NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_MAX: Highest attribute
8074  */
8075 enum nl80211_wiphy_radio_attrs {
8076 	__NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_INVALID,
8077 
8078 	NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_INDEX,
8079 	NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE,
8080 	NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATION,
8081 	NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_ANTENNA_MASK,
8082 
8083 	/* keep last */
8084 	__NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_LAST,
8085 	NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_LAST - 1,
8086 };
8087 
8088 /**
8089  * enum nl80211_wiphy_radio_freq_range - wiphy radio frequency range
8090  *
8091  * @__NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
8092  *
8093  * @NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_START: Frequency range start (u32).
8094  *	The unit is kHz.
8095  * @NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_END: Frequency range end (u32).
8096  *	The unit is kHz.
8097  *
8098  * @__NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_LAST: Internal
8099  * @NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_MAX: Highest attribute
8100  */
8101 enum nl80211_wiphy_radio_freq_range {
8102 	__NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_INVALID,
8103 
8104 	NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_START,
8105 	NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_END,
8106 
8107 	__NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_LAST,
8108 	NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_LAST - 1,
8109 };
8110 
8111 #endif /* __LINUX_NL80211_H */
8112